CANON TR4500 User Manual

TR4500 series  
Online Manual  
English  
Using Online Manual  
Operating Environment  
Printing Online Manual  
Screenshots in This Manual  
10  
 
Symbols Used in This Document  
Warning  
Instructions that, if ignored, could result in death, serious personal injury, or property damage caused by  
incorrect operation of the equipment. These must be observed for safe operation.  
Caution  
Instructions that, if ignored, could result in personal injury or property damage caused by incorrect  
operation of the equipment. These must be observed for safe operation.  
Important  
Instructions including important information that must be observed to avoid damage and injury or  
improper use of the product. Be sure to read these instructions.  
Note  
Instructions including notes for operation and additional explanations.  
Basics  
Instructions explaining basic operations of your product.  
Note  
• Icons may vary depending on your product.  
11  
 
Touch-enabled Device Users (Windows)  
For touch actions, you need to replace "right-click" in this document with the action set on the operating  
system. For example, if the action is set to "press and hold" on your operating system, replace "right-click"  
with "press and hold."  
12  
 
Trademarks and Licenses  
• Microsoft is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation.  
• Windows is a trademark or registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the U.S. and/or other  
countries.  
• Windows Vista is a trademark or registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the U.S. and/or other  
countries.  
• Internet Explorer is a trademark or registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the U.S. and/or  
other countries.  
• Mac, Mac OS, macOS, OS X, AirPort, App Store, AirPrint, the AirPrint logo, Safari, Bonjour, iPad,  
iPhone and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.  
• IOS is a trademark or registered trademark of Cisco in the U.S. and other countries and is used under  
license.  
• Google Cloud Print, Google Chrome, Chrome OS, Chromebook, Android, Google Drive, Google Apps  
and Google Analytics are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Google Inc. Google Play and  
Google Play Logo are trademarks of Google LLC.  
• Adobe, Acrobat, Flash, Photoshop, Photoshop Elements, Lightroom, Adobe RGB and Adobe RGB  
(1998) are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United  
States and/or other countries.  
• Bluetooth is a trademark of Bluetooth SIG, Inc., U.S.A. and licensed to Canon Inc.  
• Autodesk and AutoCAD are registered trademarks or trademarks of Autodesk, Inc., and/or its  
subsidiaries and/or affiliates in the USA and/or other countries.  
Note  
• The formal name of Windows Vista is Microsoft Windows Vista operating system.  
Copyright (c) 2003-2015 Apple Inc. All rights reserved.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided  
that the following conditions are met:  
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer.  
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and  
the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
3. Neither the name of Apple Inc. ("Apple") nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or  
promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY APPLE AND ITS CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS  
OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO  
EVENT SHALL APPLE OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,  
INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT  
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR  
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF  
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR  
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF  
THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
13  
 
Apache License  
Version 2.0, January 2004  
http://www.apache.org/licenses/  
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR USE, REPRODUCTION, AND DISTRIBUTION  
1. Definitions.  
"License" shall mean the terms and conditions for use, reproduction, and distribution as defined by  
Sections 1 through 9 of this document.  
"Licensor" shall mean the copyright owner or entity authorized by the copyright owner that is granting  
the License.  
"Legal Entity" shall mean the union of the acting entity and all other entities that control, are controlled  
by, or are under common control with that entity. For the purposes of this definition, "control" means  
(i) the power, direct or indirect, to cause the direction or management of such entity, whether by  
contract or otherwise, or (ii) ownership of fifty percent (50%) or more of the outstanding shares, or (iii)  
beneficial ownership of such entity.  
"You" (or "Your") shall mean an individual or Legal Entity exercising permissions granted by this  
License.  
"Source" form shall mean the preferred form for making modifications, including but not limited to  
software source code, documentation source, and configuration files.  
"Object" form shall mean any form resulting from mechanical transformation or translation of a Source  
form, including but not limited to compiled object code, generated documentation, and conversions to  
other media types.  
"Work" shall mean the work of authorship, whether in Source or Object form, made available under  
the License, as indicated by a copyright notice that is included in or attached to the work (an example  
is provided in the Appendix below).  
"Derivative Works" shall mean any work, whether in Source or Object form, that is based on (or  
derived from) the Work and for which the editorial revisions, annotations, elaborations, or other  
modifications represent, as a whole, an original work of authorship. For the purposes of this License,  
Derivative Works shall not include works that remain separable from, or merely link (or bind by name)  
to the interfaces of, the Work and Derivative Works thereof.  
"Contribution" shall mean any work of authorship, including the original version of the Work and any  
modifications or additions to that Work or Derivative Works thereof, that is intentionally submitted to  
Licensor for inclusion in the Work by the copyright owner or by an individual or Legal Entity  
authorized to submit on behalf of the copyright owner. For the purposes of this definition, "submitted"  
means any form of electronic, verbal, or written communication sent to the Licensor or its  
representatives, including but not limited to communication on electronic mailing lists, source code  
control systems, and issue tracking systems that are managed by, or on behalf of, the Licensor for  
the purpose of discussing and improving the Work, but excluding communication that is  
conspicuously marked or otherwise designated in writing by the copyright owner as "Not a  
Contribution."  
"Contributor" shall mean Licensor and any individual or Legal Entity on behalf of whom a Contribution  
has been received by Licensor and subsequently incorporated within the Work.  
14  
2. Grant of Copyright License. Subject to the terms and conditions of this License, each Contributor  
hereby grants to You a perpetual, worldwide, non-exclusive, no-charge, royalty-free, irrevocable  
copyright license to reproduce, prepare Derivative Works of, publicly display, publicly perform,  
sublicense, and distribute the Work and such Derivative Works in Source or Object form.  
3. Grant of Patent License. Subject to the terms and conditions of this License, each Contributor hereby  
grants to You a perpetual, worldwide, non-exclusive, no-charge, royalty-free, irrevocable (except as  
stated in this section) patent license to make, have made, use, offer to sell, sell, import, and  
otherwise transfer the Work, where such license applies only to those patent claims licensable by  
such Contributor that are necessarily infringed by their Contribution(s) alone or by combination of  
their Contribution(s) with the Work to which such Contribution(s) was submitted. If You institute patent  
litigation against any entity (including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that the  
Work or a Contribution incorporated within the Work constitutes direct or contributory patent  
infringement, then any patent licenses granted to You under this License for that Work shall terminate  
as of the date such litigation is filed.  
4. Redistribution. You may reproduce and distribute copies of the Work or Derivative Works thereof in  
any medium, with or without modifications, and in Source or Object form, provided that You meet the  
following conditions:  
1. You must give any other recipients of the Work or Derivative Works a copy of this License; and  
2. You must cause any modified files to carry prominent notices stating that You changed the files;  
and  
3. You must retain, in the Source form of any Derivative Works that You distribute, all copyright,  
patent, trademark, and attribution notices from the Source form of the Work, excluding those  
notices that do not pertain to any part of the Derivative Works; and  
4. If the Work includes a "NOTICE" text file as part of its distribution, then any Derivative Works that  
You distribute must include a readable copy of the attribution notices contained within such  
NOTICE file, excluding those notices that do not pertain to any part of the Derivative Works, in at  
least one of the following places: within a NOTICE text file distributed as part of the Derivative  
Works; within the Source form or documentation, if provided along with the Derivative Works; or,  
within a display generated by the Derivative Works, if and wherever such third-party notices  
normally appear. The contents of the NOTICE file are for informational purposes only and do not  
modify the License. You may add Your own attribution notices within Derivative Works that You  
distribute, alongside or as an addendum to the NOTICE text from the Work, provided that such  
additional attribution notices cannot be construed as modifying the License.  
You may add Your own copyright statement to Your modifications and may provide additional or  
different license terms and conditions for use, reproduction, or distribution of Your modifications,  
or for any such Derivative Works as a whole, provided Your use, reproduction, and distribution of  
the Work otherwise complies with the conditions stated in this License.  
5. Submission of Contributions. Unless You explicitly state otherwise, any Contribution intentionally  
submitted for inclusion in the Work by You to the Licensor shall be under the terms and conditions of  
this License, without any additional terms or conditions. Notwithstanding the above, nothing herein  
shall supersede or modify the terms of any separate license agreement you may have executed with  
Licensor regarding such Contributions.  
6. Trademarks. This License does not grant permission to use the trade names, trademarks, service  
marks, or product names of the Licensor, except as required for reasonable and customary use in  
describing the origin of the Work and reproducing the content of the NOTICE file.  
15  
7. Disclaimer of Warranty. Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, Licensor provides  
the Work (and each Contributor provides its Contributions) on an "AS IS" BASIS, WITHOUT  
WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied, including, without  
limitation, any warranties or conditions of TITLE, NON-INFRINGEMENT, MERCHANTABILITY, or  
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. You are solely responsible for determining the  
appropriateness of using or redistributing the Work and assume any risks associated with Your  
exercise of permissions under this License.  
8. Limitation of Liability. In no event and under no legal theory, whether in tort (including negligence),  
contract, or otherwise, unless required by applicable law (such as deliberate and grossly negligent  
acts) or agreed to in writing, shall any Contributor be liable to You for damages, including any direct,  
indirect, special, incidental, or consequential damages of any character arising as a result of this  
License or out of the use or inability to use the Work (including but not limited to damages for loss of  
goodwill, work stoppage, computer failure or malfunction, or any and all other commercial damages  
or losses), even if such Contributor has been advised of the possibility of such damages.  
9. Accepting Warranty or Additional Liability. While redistributing the Work or Derivative Works thereof,  
You may choose to offer, and charge a fee for, acceptance of support, warranty, indemnity, or other  
liability obligations and/or rights consistent with this License. However, in accepting such obligations,  
You may act only on Your own behalf and on Your sole responsibility, not on behalf of any other  
Contributor, and only if You agree to indemnify, defend, and hold each Contributor harmless for any  
liability incurred by, or claims asserted against, such Contributor by reason of your accepting any  
such warranty or additional liability.  
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS  
---- Part 1: CMU/UCD copyright notice: (BSD like) -----  
Copyright 1989, 1991, 1992 by Carnegie Mellon University  
Derivative Work - 1996, 1998-2000  
Copyright 1996, 1998-2000 The Regents of the University of California  
All Rights Reserved  
Permission to use, copy, modify and distribute this software and its documentation for any purpose and  
without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above copyright notice appears in all copies and that both  
that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in supporting documentation, and that the name of  
CMU and The Regents of the University of California not be used in advertising or publicity pertaining to  
distribution of the software without specific written permission.  
CMU AND THE REGENTS OF THE UNIVERSITY OF CALIFORNIA DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES  
WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL CMU OR THE REGENTS OF THE  
UNIVERSITY OF CALIFORNIA BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL  
DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM THE LOSS OF USE, DATA OR  
PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,  
ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.  
---- Part 2: Networks Associates Technology, Inc copyright notice (BSD) -----  
Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Networks Associates Technology, Inc  
All rights reserved.  
16  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided  
that the following conditions are met:  
* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer.  
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
* Neither the name of the Networks Associates Technology, Inc nor the names of its contributors may be  
used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS''  
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED  
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE  
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE  
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL  
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR  
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER  
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR  
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF  
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
---- Part 3: Cambridge Broadband Ltd. copyright notice (BSD) -----  
Portions of this code are copyright (c) 2001-2003, Cambridge Broadband Ltd.  
All rights reserved.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided  
that the following conditions are met:  
* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer.  
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
* The name of Cambridge Broadband Ltd. may not be used to endorse or promote products derived from  
this software without specific prior written permission.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR  
IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO  
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,  
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,  
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR  
BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER  
IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING  
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF  
SUCH DAMAGE.  
---- Part 4: Sun Microsystems, Inc. copyright notice (BSD) -----  
Copyright c 2003 Sun Microsystems, Inc., 4150 Network Circle, Santa Clara, California 95054, U.S.A. All  
rights reserved.  
17  
Use is subject to license terms below.  
This distribution may include materials developed by third parties.  
Sun, Sun Microsystems, the Sun logo and Solaris are trademarks or registered trademarks of Sun  
Microsystems, Inc. in the U.S. and other countries.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided  
that the following conditions are met:  
* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer.  
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
* Neither the name of the Sun Microsystems, Inc. nor the names of its contributors may be used to  
endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS''  
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED  
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE  
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE  
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL  
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR  
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER  
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR  
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF  
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
---- Part 5: Sparta, Inc copyright notice (BSD) -----  
Copyright (c) 2003-2012, Sparta, Inc  
All rights reserved.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided  
that the following conditions are met:  
* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer.  
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
* Neither the name of Sparta, Inc nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote  
products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS''  
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED  
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE  
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE  
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL  
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR  
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER  
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR  
18  
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF  
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
---- Part 6: Cisco/BUPTNIC copyright notice (BSD) -----  
Copyright (c) 2004, Cisco, Inc and Information Network Center of Beijing University of Posts and  
Telecommunications.  
All rights reserved.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided  
that the following conditions are met:  
* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer.  
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
* Neither the name of Cisco, Inc, Beijing University of Posts and Telecommunications, nor the names of  
their contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific  
prior written permission.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS''  
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED  
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE  
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE  
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL  
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR  
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER  
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR  
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF  
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
---- Part 7: Fabasoft R&D Software GmbH & Co KG copyright notice (BSD) -----  
Copyright (c) Fabasoft R&D Software GmbH & Co KG, 2003 [email protected]  
Author: Bernhard Penz <[email protected]>  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided  
that the following conditions are met:  
* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer.  
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
* The name of Fabasoft R&D Software GmbH & Co KG or any of its subsidiaries, brand or product names  
may not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written  
permission.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR  
IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO  
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,  
19  
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,  
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR  
BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER  
IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING  
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF  
SUCH DAMAGE.  
---- Part 8: Apple Inc. copyright notice (BSD) -----  
Copyright (c) 2007 Apple Inc. All rights reserved.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided  
that the following conditions are met:  
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer.  
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and  
the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
3. Neither the name of Apple Inc. ("Apple") nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or  
promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY APPLE AND ITS CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS  
OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO  
EVENT SHALL APPLE OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,  
INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT  
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR  
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF  
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR  
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF  
THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
---- Part 9: ScienceLogic, LLC copyright notice (BSD) -----  
Copyright (c) 2009, ScienceLogic, LLC  
All rights reserved.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided  
that the following conditions are met:  
* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer.  
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
* Neither the name of ScienceLogic, LLC nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or  
promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND  
ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED  
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE  
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE  
20  
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL  
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR  
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER  
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR  
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF  
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
LEADTOOLS  
Copyright (C) 1991-2009 LEAD Technologies, Inc.  
CMap Resources  
-----------------------------------------------------------  
Copyright 1990-2009 Adobe Systems Incorporated.  
All rights reserved.  
Copyright 1990-2010 Adobe Systems Incorporated.  
All rights reserved.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or  
without modification, are permitted provided that the  
following conditions are met:  
Redistributions of source code must retain the above  
copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following  
disclaimer.  
Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above  
copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following  
disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials  
provided with the distribution.  
Neither the name of Adobe Systems Incorporated nor the names  
of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote  
products derived from this software without specific prior  
written permission.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND  
CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,  
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE  
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR  
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,  
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT  
NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;  
LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)  
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN  
CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR  
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS  
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
-----------------------------------------------------------  
21  
MIT License  
Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source Software Center Ltd  
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and  
associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including  
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies  
of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following  
conditions:  
The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial  
portions of the Software.  
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR  
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS  
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR  
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER  
IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN  
CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.  
Copyright 2000 Computing Research Labs, New Mexico State University  
Copyright 2001-2015 Francesco Zappa Nardelli  
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and  
associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including  
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies  
of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following  
conditions:  
The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial  
portions of the Software.  
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR  
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS  
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COMPUTING  
RESEARCH LAB OR NEW MEXICO STATE UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR  
OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING  
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN  
THE SOFTWARE.  
Written by Joel Sherrill <[email protected]>.  
COPYRIGHT (c) 1989-2000.  
On-Line Applications Research Corporation (OAR).  
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any purpose without fee is hereby  
granted, provided that this entire notice is included in all copies of any software which is or includes a  
copy or modification of this software.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS BEING PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTY.  
IN PARTICULAR, THE AUTHOR MAKES NO REPRESENTATION OR WARRANTY OF ANY KIND  
22  
CONCERNING THE MERCHANTABILITY OF THIS SOFTWARE OR ITS FITNESS FOR ANY  
PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  
(1) Red Hat Incorporated  
Copyright (c) 1994-2009 Red Hat, Inc. All rights reserved.  
This copyrighted material is made available to anyone wishing to use, modify, copy, or redistribute it  
subject to the terms and conditions of the BSD License. This program is distributed in the hope that it will  
be useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY expressed or implied, including the implied warranties of  
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. A copy of this license is available at  
http://www.opensource.org/licenses. Any Red Hat trademarks that are incorporated in the source code or  
documentation are not subject to the BSD License and may only be used or replicated with the express  
permission of Red Hat, Inc.  
(2) University of California, Berkeley  
Copyright (c) 1981-2000 The Regents of the University of California.  
All rights reserved.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided  
that the following conditions are met:  
* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer.  
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the  
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
* Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote  
products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND  
ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED  
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE  
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR  
ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;  
LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON  
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING  
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE,  
EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
The FreeType Project LICENSE  
----------------------------  
2006-Jan-27  
Copyright 1996-2002, 2006 by  
David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg  
Introduction  
============  
23  
The FreeType Project is distributed in several archive packages; some of them may contain, in addition to  
the FreeType font engine, various tools and contributions which rely on, or relate to, the FreeType Project.  
This license applies to all files found in such packages, and which do not fall under their own explicit  
license. The license affects thus the FreeType font engine, the test programs, documentation and  
makefiles, at the very least.  
This license was inspired by the BSD, Artistic, and IJG (Independent JPEG Group) licenses, which all  
encourage inclusion and use of free software in commercial and freeware products alike. As a  
consequence, its main points are that:  
o We don't promise that this software works. However, we will be interested in any kind of bug reports.  
(`as is' distribution)  
o You can use this software for whatever you want, in parts or full form, without having to pay us.  
(`royalty-free' usage)  
o You may not pretend that you wrote this software. If you use it, or only parts of it, in a program, you  
must acknowledge somewhere in your documentation that you have used the FreeType code. (`credits')  
We specifically permit and encourage the inclusion of this software, with or without modifications, in  
commercial products.  
We disclaim all warranties covering The FreeType Project and assume no liability related to The  
FreeType Project.  
Finally, many people asked us for a preferred form for a credit/disclaimer to use in compliance with this  
license. We thus encourage you to use the following text:  
"""  
Portions of this software are copyright © <year> The FreeType  
Project (www.freetype.org). All rights reserved.  
"""  
Please replace <year> with the value from the FreeType version you actually use.  
Legal Terms  
===========  
0. Definitions  
--------------  
Throughout this license, the terms `package', `FreeType Project', and `FreeType archive' refer to the set  
of files originally distributed by the authors (David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg) as the  
`FreeType Project', be they named as alpha, beta or final release.  
`You' refers to the licensee, or person using the project, where `using' is a generic term including  
compiling the project's source code as well as linking it to form a `program' or `executable'.  
This program is referred to as `a program using the FreeType engine'.  
This license applies to all files distributed in the original FreeType Project, including all source code,  
binaries and documentation, unless otherwise stated in the file in its original, unmodified form as  
distributed in the original archive.  
If you are unsure whether or not a particular file is covered by this license, you must contact us to verify  
this.  
24  
The FreeType Project is copyright (C) 1996-2000 by David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg.  
All rights reserved except as specified below.  
1. No Warranty  
--------------  
THE FREETYPE PROJECT IS PROVIDED `AS IS' WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER  
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  
AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. IN NO EVENT WILL ANY OF THE AUTHORS OR  
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES CAUSED BY THE USE OR THE INABILITY  
TO USE, OF THE FREETYPE PROJECT.  
2. Redistribution  
-----------------  
This license grants a worldwide, royalty-free, perpetual and irrevocable right and license to use, execute,  
perform, compile, display, copy, create derivative works of, distribute and sublicense the FreeType Project  
(in both source and object code forms) and derivative works thereof for any purpose; and to authorize  
others to exercise some or all of the rights granted herein, subject to the following conditions:  
o Redistribution of source code must retain this license file (`FTL.TXT') unaltered; any additions, deletions  
or changes to the original files must be clearly indicated in accompanying documentation. The copyright  
notices of the unaltered, original files must be preserved in all copies of source files.  
o Redistribution in binary form must provide a disclaimer that states that the software is based in part of  
the work of the FreeType Team, in the distribution documentation. We also encourage you to put an URL  
to the FreeType web page in your documentation, though this isn't mandatory.  
These conditions apply to any software derived from or based on the FreeType Project, not just the  
unmodified files. If you use our work, you must acknowledge us. However, no fee need be paid to us.  
3. Advertising  
--------------  
Neither the FreeType authors and contributors nor you shall use the name of the other for commercial,  
advertising, or promotional purposes without specific prior written permission.  
We suggest, but do not require, that you use one or more of the following phrases to refer to this software  
in your documentation or advertising materials: `FreeType Project', `FreeType Engine', `FreeType library',  
or `FreeType Distribution'.  
As you have not signed this license, you are not required to accept it. However, as the FreeType Project  
is copyrighted material, only this license, or another one contracted with the authors, grants you the right  
to use, distribute, and modify it.  
Therefore, by using, distributing, or modifying the FreeType Project, you indicate that you understand and  
accept all the terms of this license.  
4. Contacts  
-----------  
There are two mailing lists related to FreeType:  
25  
Discusses general use and applications of FreeType, as well as future and wanted additions to the library  
and distribution.  
If you are looking for support, start in this list if you haven't found anything to help you in the  
documentation.  
Discusses bugs, as well as engine internals, design issues, specific licenses, porting, etc.  
Our home page can be found at  
http://www.freetype.org  
--- end of FTL.TXT ---  
The TWAIN Toolkit is distributed as is. The developer and distributors of the TWAIN Toolkit expressly  
disclaim all implied, express or statutory warranties including, without limitation, the implied warranties of  
merchantability, noninfringement of third party rights and fitness for a particular purpose. Neither the  
developers nor the distributors will be liable for damages, whether direct, indirect, special, incidental, or  
consequential, as a result of the reproduction, modification, distribution or other use of the TWAIN Toolkit.  
JSON for Modern C++  
Copyright (c) 2013-2017 Niels Lohmann  
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and  
associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including  
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies  
of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following  
conditions:  
The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial  
portions of the Software.  
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR  
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS  
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR  
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER  
IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN  
CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.  
The following applies only to products supporting Wi-Fi.  
(c) 2009-2013 by Jeff Mott. All rights reserved.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided  
that the following conditions are met:  
* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions, and the  
following disclaimer.  
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions, and the  
following disclaimer in the documentation or other materials provided with the distribution.  
* Neither the name CryptoJS nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote  
products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.  
26  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS,"  
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED  
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, ARE  
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE  
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL  
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR  
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER  
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR  
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF  
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
27  
Printing Photos from a Computer  
This section describes how to print photos with Easy-PhotoPrint Editor.  
1. Open the front cover (A) gently.  
The paper output tray (B) opens.  
2. Pull out the cassette until it stops.  
3. Use the right paper guide (C) to slide both paper guides all the way out.  
4. Load photo paper in portrait orientation WITH PRINT SIDE FACING DOWN.  
29  
 
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
5. Slide the right paper guide (C) to align the paper guides with both sides of the paper stack.  
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
6. Push cassette back until arrow ( ) on front cover is aligned with edge of printer.  
After pushing the cassette back, the paper information registration screen for the cassette is displayed  
on the LCD.  
30  
7. Press the OK button.  
8. Use the  
OK button.  
button to select the size of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the  
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
9. Use the  
OK button.  
button to select the type of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the  
Follow the instructions of any messages displayed to register the paper information.  
10. Pull the paper output support (D) out from the paper output tray.  
11. Open the output tray extension (E).  
31  
12. Start Easy-PhotoPrint Editor.  
For Windows:  
The procedure below is for a computer running the Windows 10 operating system.  
From the Start menu, select (All apps >) Canon Utilities > Easy-PhotoPrint Editor.  
For macOS:  
From the Go menu in Finder, select Application and double-click the Canon Utilities folder, the Easy-  
PhotoPrint Editor folder, and then the Easy-PhotoPrint Editor icon.  
13. Click Photos icon (F).  
14. Click Browse (G) in From computer: and select folder with photos you want to print.  
15. Click photos (H) you want to print and select Open (I).  
For Windows:  
To select two or more photos at a time, click photos while pressing the Ctrl key.  
For macOS:  
To select two or more photos at a time, click photos while pressing the command key.  
32  
16. Specify number of copies and other options under Print Settings (J).  
For Windows:  
Specify the number of copies, your model name, the paper size, and other options.  
For macOS:  
Specify the number of copies, the paper size, and other options.  
Note  
• Selecting Same No. of each photo enables you to specify the number of copies for all photos  
with a single setting.  
• Selecting Same No. of each photo disables the number-of-copies setting specified for each  
photo. When unchecked, the previous settings for each copy are re-enabled.  
the number of copies is also re-enabled.  
for specifying  
17. Start printing.  
For Windows:  
Click Print (K).  
For macOS:  
Click Next. When the Print dialog appears, specify your model name, paper, and other options, and then  
click Print.  
33  
Note  
• Easy-PhotoPrint Editor lets you easily create and print original collages, cards, or calendars using your  
favorite photos.  
Easy-PhotoPrint Editor Guide  
34  
Printing Photos from a Smartphone/Tablet  
This section describes how to print photos with Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY.  
For details on how to download Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY, see below.  
Print Easily from a Smartphone or Tablet with Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY  
1. Open the front cover (A) gently.  
The paper output tray (B) opens.  
2. Pull out the cassette until it stops.  
3. Use the right paper guide (C) to slide both paper guides all the way out.  
4. Load photo paper in portrait orientation WITH PRINT SIDE FACING DOWN.  
35  
 
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
5. Slide the right paper guide (C) to align the paper guides with both sides of the paper stack.  
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
6. Push cassette back until arrow ( ) on front cover is aligned with edge of printer.  
After pushing the cassette back, the paper information registration screen for the cassette is displayed  
on the LCD.  
36  
7. Press the OK button.  
8. Use the  
OK button.  
button to select the size of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the  
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
9. Use the  
OK button.  
button to select the type of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the  
Follow the instructions of any messages displayed to register the paper information.  
10. Pull the paper output support (D) out from the paper output tray.  
11. Open the output tray extension (E).  
37  
12. Start  
(Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY) from your smartphone/tablet.  
13. Select Photo Print on Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY.  
The list of photos saved on your smartphone/tablet is displayed.  
14. Select a photo.  
You can also select multiple photos at once.  
15. Specify the number of copies, paper size, etc.  
16. Select Print.  
38  
Copying  
This section describes how to load originals and copy them to plain paper loaded.  
1. Open the front cover (A) gently.  
The paper output tray (B) opens.  
2. Pull out the cassette until it stops.  
3. Use the right paper guide (C) to slide both paper guides all the way out.  
4. Load plain paper in portrait orientation WITH PRINT SIDE FACING DOWN.  
39  
 
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
5. Slide the right paper guide (C) to align the paper guides with both sides of the paper stack.  
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
6. Push cassette back until arrow ( ) on front cover is aligned with edge of printer.  
After pushing the cassette back, the paper information registration screen for the cassette is displayed  
on the LCD.  
40  
7. Press the OK button.  
8. Use the  
OK button.  
button to select the size of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the  
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
9. Use the  
OK button.  
button to select the type of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the  
Follow the instructions of any messages displayed to register the paper information.  
10. Pull the paper output support (D) out from the paper output tray.  
11. Open the output tray extension (E).  
41  
12. Press the COPY button (F).  
13. Open the document cover (G).  
14. Load the original WITH THE SIDE TO COPY FACING DOWN and align it with the  
alignment mark (H).  
Note  
• To copy two or more documents continuously, load them in the ADF (Auto Document Feeder).  
42  
15. Close the document cover gently.  
16. Confirm the paper settings, then press the Black button (I) or Color button (J).  
Important  
• Do not open the document cover until copying is complete.  
Note  
• Your printer is equipped with many other convenient copy features.  
43  
Faxing  
Fax multiple documents in black and white as follows.  
1. Open the document tray (A).  
2. Slide the document guide (B) all the way out.  
3. Insert the document WITH THE SIDE TO SCAN FACING UP.  
4. Align document guide (B) with document width.  
44  
 
5. Press the FAX button (C).  
6. Use the Numeric buttons (D) to enter the fax number.  
7. Press the Black button (E).  
Note  
• Many other convenient faxing features are available.  
45  
Network  
Available Connection Methods  
The following connection methods are available on the printer.  
• Wireless Connection  
Connect the printer and devices (e.g. computer/smartphone/tablet) using a wireless router.  
If you have a wireless router, we recommend you use one for wireless connection.  
◦ Connection methods vary depending on the wireless router type.  
◦ You can change network settings such as the network name (SSID) and security protocol on the  
printer.  
◦ When the connection between a device and a wireless router is completed and  
displayed in the device's screen, you can connect the device to the printer using the wireless router.  
• Wireless Direct  
(Wi-Fi icon) is  
Connect the printer and devices (e.g. computer/smartphone/tablet) without using a wireless router.  
◦ While you are using the printer with Wireless Direct, Internet connection from the printer becomes  
unavailable. In that case, web services for the printer cannot be used.  
◦ If you connect a device connected to the Internet via a wireless router to the printer that is in the  
Wireless Direct, the connection between the device and wireless router will be disabled. In that case,  
the connection of the device may switch to a mobile data connection automatically depending on  
your device. Transmission fees for connecting to the Internet using a mobile data connection apply.  
◦ In the Wireless Direct, you can connect up to five devices at the same time. If you try to connect a  
sixth device while five devices are already connected, an error will appear. If an error appears,  
disconnect a device you do not use and configure settings again.  
◦ Network settings such as the network name (SSID) and security protocol are specified automatically.  
Note  
• You can connect the printer and computer using a USB cable (USB connection). Prepare a USB  
Network Connection Settings/Setup  
Perform connection setup for the printer and computer/smartphone/tablet.  
For more on setup procedure, click here.  
46  
 
Changing Network Settings  
See below for changing connection settings for the printer and computer/smartphone/tablet.  
• To change network connection method:  
Changing the Connection Mode  
• To add computer/smartphone/tablet to the printer:  
• To use Wireless Direct temporarily:  
IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
IJ Network Device Setup Utility checks or diagnoses the settings of the printer and those of computer and  
restores the status of them if anything is wrong with network connection. Select either link below to download  
IJ Network Device Setup Utility.  
Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
• Performing/Changing Network Settings (Windows)  
For Windows, you can perform network settings using IJ Network Device Setup Utility.  
IJ Network Device Setup Utility (Windows)  
• Diagnosing and Repairing Network Settings (Windows/macOS)  
You can diagnose or repair network settings using IJ Network Device Setup Utility.  
◦ For Windows:  
IJ Network Device Setup Utility (Windows)  
◦ For macOS:  
Network Connection Tips  
See below for tips on using the printer via network connection.  
Handling Printer Configuration using the Web Browser  
Troubleshooting  
See Network Settings and Common Problems for troubleshooting on network connection.  
Notice/Restriction  
See below for details.  
• Restrictions on network settings:  
• Notices when printing using web service:  
Notice for Web Service Printing  
47  
Restrictions  
When connecting another device while a device (such as a computer) is already connected to the printer,  
connect it using the same connection method as the connected device.  
If you connect using a different connection method, the connection to the device in use will be disabled.  
Connect via wireless router  
• Make sure your device and the wireless router are connected. For details on checking these settings,  
see the manual supplied with the wireless router or contact its manufacturer.  
As for a device already connected to the printer without using a wireless router, reconnect it via a  
wireless router.  
• Configuration, router functions, setup procedures and security settings of wireless routers vary  
depending on the system environment. For details, see the manual for your wireless router or contact  
its manufacturer.  
• This printer does not support IEEE802.11ac. IEEE802.11a and IEEE802.11n (5 GHz) may not be  
supported depending on the country or region you live in. Check if your device supports IEEE802.11n,  
IEEE802.11g, IEEE802.11b or IEEE802.11a.  
• If your device is set to the "IEEE802.11n only" mode, WEP or TKIP cannot be used as a security  
protocol. Change the security protocol for your device to something other than WEP and TKIP or  
change the setting to something other than "IEEE802.11n only."  
The connection between your device and the wireless router will be temporarily disabled while the  
setting is changed. Do not proceed to the next screen of this guide until setup is complete.  
• For office use, consult your network administrator.  
• Note that if you connect to a network with no security protection, your personal information could be  
disclosed to a third party.  
Wireless Direct  
Important  
• If a device is connected to the Internet via a wireless router, and you then connect it to a printer in  
Wireless Direct mode, the existing connection between the device and wireless router will be  
disabled. In that case, the connection of the device may switch to a mobile data connection  
automatically depending on your device. When you connect to the Internet using a mobile data  
connection, charges may apply depending on your contract.  
• When you connect a device and the printer using Wireless Direct, the connection information will  
be saved to Wi-Fi settings. The device may be connected to the printer automatically even after  
disconnecting it or connecting it to another wireless router.  
• To prevent automatic connection to the printer in Wireless Direct mode, change the connection  
mode after using the printer, or set not to connect automatically in the Wi-Fi settings of the  
device.  
For details on checking or changing the wireless router settings, see the wireless router manual  
or contact its manufacturer.  
• If you connect a device and the printer using Wireless Direct, Internet connection may become  
unavailable depending on your environment. In that case, web services for the printer cannot be used.  
48  
 
• In Wireless Direct mode, you can connect up to five devices at the same time. If you try to connect a  
sixth device while five devices are already connected, an error will appear.  
If an error appears, disconnect a device that does not use the printer, then configure settings again.  
• Devices connected to the printer using Wireless Direct cannot communicate with each other.  
• Firmware updates for the printer are not available while using Wireless Direct.  
• When a device has been connected to the printer without using a wireless router and you want to set  
it up again using the same connection method, disconnect it first. Disable the connection between the  
device and printer in the Wi-Fi setting screen.  
49  
Default Network Settings  
LAN Connection Defaults  
Item  
Default  
Enable/Disable LAN  
SSID  
Disable LAN  
BJNPSETUP  
Disable  
Wi-Fi security  
IP address (IPv4)  
IP address (IPv6)  
Set printer name*  
Enable/disable IPv6  
Auto setup  
Auto setup  
XXXXXXXXXXXX  
Enable  
Enable/disable WSD Enable  
Timeout setting  
15 minutes  
Enab./disab. Bonjour Enable  
Service name  
LPR setting  
RAW protocol  
LLMNR  
Canon TR4500 series  
Active  
Active  
Active  
("XX" represents alphanumeric characters.)  
* Default value depends on printer. To check value, use operation panel.  
Wireless Direct Defaults  
Item  
Default  
Network name (SSID) for wireless direct DIRECT-abXX-TR4500series *1  
WL Direct dev. name  
Password  
DIRECT-abXX-TR4500series *1  
YYYYYYYYYY *2  
Security method  
Confirm request  
WPA2-PSK (AES)  
Displayed  
51  
 
*1 "ab" is specified at random and "XX" represents last two digits of printer's MAC address. (The value is  
specified when the printer is turned on for the first time.)  
*2 The password is specified automatically when the printer is turned on for the first time.  
52  
Detect Same Printer Name  
When the printer is detected during setup, plural printers with the same name may appear on the results  
screen.  
Select a printer with checking the printer settings against those on detection result screen.  
• For Windows:  
Check the printer's MAC address or serial to select the correct printer from the results.  
• For macOS:  
The printer names appear with the MAC address added at the end or as the printer name specified by  
Bonjour.  
Check identifiers such as the MAC address, the printer name specified by Bonjour, and the printer's  
serial number to select the printer from among those that appear.  
Note  
• Serial number may not appear on result screen.  
To check the printer's MAC address and the serial number, print out the network settings information.  
Note  
• You can check the serial number by displaying on the LCD.  
53  
 
Connects to Another Computer via LAN/Changes from USB to  
LAN Connection  
For Windows:  
To add a computer to connect to the printer on a LAN or to change from USB to LAN connection, perform  
setup using the Setup CD-ROM or from the web page.  
For macOS:  
To connect an additional computer to the printer via LAN, or to change from USB to LAN connection,  
perform setup from the web page.  
54  
     
Printing Network Settings  
Use the operation panel to print the printer's current network settings.  
Important  
• The network settings printout contains important information about your network. Handle it with care.  
3. Press Setup button.  
The Setup menu screen appears.  
4. Select Device settings and press OK button.  
5. Select LAN settings and press OK button.  
6. Select Print LAN details and press OK button.  
The printer starts printing the network setting information.  
The following information on the printer's network setting is printed out. (Some setting values are not  
displayed depending on the printer settings.)  
Item Num- Item  
ber  
Description  
Setting  
1
Product Information  
Product information  
Product name  
ROM version  
1-1  
1-2  
1-3  
2
Product Name  
ROM Version  
XXXXXXXX  
XXXXXXXX  
XXXXXXXX  
Serial Number  
Network Diagnostics  
Diagnostic Result  
Result Codes  
Serial number  
Network diagnostics  
Diagnostic result  
Result codes  
2-1  
2-2  
2-3  
3
XXXXXXXX  
XXXXXXXX  
http://canon.com/ijnwt  
Enable/Disable  
Enable/Disable  
0 to 100 [%]  
0 to 100 [%]  
Result Code Details  
Wireless LAN  
Result code details  
Wireless LAN  
3-2  
3-2-1  
3-2-2  
Infrastructure  
Infrastructure  
Signal Strength  
Link Quality  
Signal strength  
Link quality  
55  
 
3-2-3  
Frequency  
Frequency  
XX (GHz)  
3-2-4  
MAC Address  
Connection  
SSID  
MAC address  
Connection status  
SSID  
XX:XX:XX:XX:XX:XX  
Active/Inactive  
3-2-5  
3-2-6  
Wireless LAN network name (SSID)  
XX (1 to 13)  
3-2-7  
Channel  
Channel  
3-2-8  
Encryption  
Encryption method  
WEP key length (bits)  
None/WEP/TKIP/AES  
Inactive/128/64  
3-2-9  
WEP Key Length  
Authentication  
TCP/IPv4  
3-2-10  
3-2-11  
3-2-12  
3-2-13  
3-2-14  
3-2-15  
3-2-16  
Authentication method None/auto/open/shared/WPA-PSK/WPA2-PSK  
TCP/IPv4  
Enable  
IP Address  
IP address  
XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX  
XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX  
XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX  
Enable/Disable  
Subnet Mask  
Default Gateway  
TCP/IPv6  
Subnet mask  
Default gateway  
TCP/IPv6  
Link Local Address  
Link local address  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
3-2-17  
3-2-18  
Link Local Prefix  
Length  
Link local prefix length XXX  
Stateless Address1  
Stateless address 1  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
3-2-19  
3-2-20  
Stateless Prefix  
Length1  
Stateless prefix length XXX  
1
Stateless Address2  
Stateless address 2  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
3-2-21  
3-2-22  
Stateless Prefix  
Length2  
Stateless prefix length XXX  
2
Stateless Address3  
Stateless address 3  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
3-2-23  
3-2-24  
Stateless Prefix  
Length3  
Stateless prefix length XXX  
3
Stateless Address4  
Stateless address 4  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
3-2-25  
Stateless Prefix  
Length4  
Stateless prefix length XXX  
4
56  
3-2-26  
3-2-27  
3-2-28  
3-2-29  
Default Gateway1  
Default Gateway2  
Default Gateway3  
Default Gateway4  
Default gateway 1  
Default gateway 2  
Default gateway 3  
Default gateway 4  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
3-2-33  
3-2-34  
3-3  
IPsec  
IPsec setting  
Active  
Security Protocol  
Wireless Direct  
Security method  
ESP/ESP & AH/AH  
Enable/Disable  
Operation mode for  
Wireless Direct  
3-3-1  
3-3-2  
3-3-3  
3-3-4  
3-3-5  
3-3-6  
3-3-7  
3-3-8  
3-3-9  
3-3-10  
3-3-11  
3-3-12  
3-3-13  
MAC Address  
Connection  
SSID  
MAC address  
Connection status  
SSID  
XX:XX:XX:XX:XX:XX  
Active/Inactive  
Wireless Direct network name (SSID)  
Password  
Password  
Wireless Direct password (10 alphanumeric characters)  
Channel  
Channel  
3
Encryption  
Encryption method  
AES  
Authentication  
TCP/IPv4  
Authentication method WPA2-PSK  
TCP/IPv4  
Enable  
IP Address  
Subnet Mask  
Default Gateway  
TCP/IPv6  
IP address  
XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX  
XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX  
XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX  
Enable/Disable  
Subnet mask  
Default gateway  
TCP/IPv6  
Link Local Address  
Link local address  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX  
3-3-14  
Link Local Prefix  
Length  
Link local prefix length XXX  
3-3-15  
3-3-16  
5
IPsec  
IPsec setting  
Active  
Security Protocol  
Other Settings  
Security method  
Other settings  
57  
5-1  
5-2  
Printer Name  
Printer name  
Printer name (Up to 15 alphanumeric characters)  
Wireless Direct Dev-  
Name  
Device name for wire-  
less direct  
Device name for wireless direct (Up to 32 alphanumeric  
characters)  
5-4  
WSD Printing  
WSD Timeout  
LPD Printing  
RAW Printing  
Bonjour  
WSD printing setting  
Timeout  
Enable/Disable  
5-5  
1/5/10/15/20 [min]  
5-6  
LPD printing setting  
RAW printing setting  
Bonjour setting  
Enable/Disable  
5-7  
Enable/Disable  
5-9  
Enable/Disable  
5-10  
5-11  
5-12  
5-14  
Bonjour Service Name Bonjour service name  
Bonjour service name (Up to 52 alphanumeric characters)  
LLMNR  
LLMNR setting  
SNMP setting  
Enable/Disable  
Enable/Disable  
SNMP  
DNS Server  
Obtain DNS server ad- Auto/Manual  
dress automatically  
5-15  
5-16  
Primary Server  
Primary server address XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX  
Secondary Server  
Secondary server ad-  
dress  
XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX  
5-17  
5-18  
5-19  
5-20  
Proxy Server  
Proxy Address  
Proxy Port  
Proxy server setting  
Proxy address  
Enable/Disable  
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX  
Proxy port specification 1 to 65535  
Cert. Fingerprt(SHA-1) Certificate finger-  
print(SHA-1)  
xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
5-21  
Cert. Fin-  
Certificate finger-  
print(SHA-256)  
xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx  
gerprt(SHA-256)  
("XX" represents alphanumeric characters.)  
58  
Reconfiguration Method of Wi-Fi Connection  
Follow either procedure below to change Wi-Fi connection method (infrastructure or Wireless Direct).  
For Windows:  
◦ Redo setup using the Setup CD-ROM or from the web page.  
◦ Perform settings on the Network Settings screen on IJ Network Device Setup Utility.  
Important  
• Before you perform settings using IJ Network Device Setup Utility, turn on Easy wireless  
connect mode on the printer following the procedure below.  
2. Press Setup button.  
The Setup menu screen appears.  
3. Select Wi-Fi setup and press OK button.  
4. Select Easy Wi-Fi connect and press OK button.  
Follow instructions on your smartphone or tablet.  
5. If message saying setup is completed appears, press OK button.  
For macOS:  
Redo setup from the web page.  
59  
 
IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
If anything is wrong with connection, IJ Network Device Setup Utility diagnoses the settings of the printer  
and those of computer on which it is installed. In addition, IJ Network Device Setup Utility restores the status  
of the printer and computer.  
Important  
• To use the printer over LAN, make sure you have the equipment necessary for the connection type,  
such as a wireless router or a LAN cable.  
• When you install IJ Network Device Setup Utility, disable block function of firewall.  
61  
 
Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
Start up Launchpad, select Canon Utilities, and then select IJ Network Device Setup Utility.  
When you start up IJ Network Device Setup Utility, the screen below appears.  
Enter the password specified for your computer and select Install Helper. IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
starts diagnosis and repair of network.  
62  
 
Diagnosing and Repairing Network Settings  
IJ Network Device Setup Utility diagnoses and repairs computer settings or connection between the  
computer and printer when a problem (e.g. cannot print from a printer on the network) occurs.  
Important  
• Some models do not support diagnosis and repair function.  
For details:  
IJ Network Device Setup Utility starts checking the computer settings when it starts up. Perform operations  
following the instructions on the screen.  
Note  
• This function checks the following items:  
• whether the computer is connected to the router  
• whether the printer can be detected on the network  
• whether the signal strength or communication level is sufficient (when using Wi-Fi)  
• whether the printer port setting matches with the network setting  
63  
 
List of Models Which Does Not Support Diagnosis and Repair  
Function  
The following models does not support "Diagnose and Repair" function of IJ Network Device Setup Utility.  
• G4000 series  
• PRO-500 series  
• PRO-1000 series  
• MB2100 series  
• MB2700 series  
• MB5100 series  
• MB5400 series  
• iB4000 series  
• PRO-520  
• PRO-540  
• PRO-560  
• PRO-540S  
• PRO-560S  
• PRO-2000  
• PRO-4000  
• PRO-6000  
• PRO-4000S  
• PRO-6000S  
• TS9000 series  
• TS8000 series  
• TS6000 series  
• TS5000 series  
• MG3000 series  
• E470 series  
64  
 
Handling Paper, Originals, FINE Cartridges, etc.  
65  
 
Loading Plain Paper  
You can load plain paper.  
Important  
• If you cut plain paper to a size of 5" x 7" (13 x 18 cm) or smaller to perform a trial print, it may cause a  
paper jam.  
Note  
• You can use general copy paper or Canon Red Label Superior WOP111/Canon Océ Office Colour  
Paper SAT213.  
For the page size and paper weight you can use for this printer, see Supported Media Types.  
1. Prepare paper.  
Align the edges of paper. If paper is curled, flatten it.  
Note  
• Align the edges of paper neatly before loading. Loading paper without aligning the edges may  
cause paper jams.  
• If paper is curled, hold the curled corners and gently bend them in the opposite direction until the  
paper becomes completely flat.  
Check3  
For details on how to flatten curled paper, see  
2. Open the front cover (A) gently.  
The paper output tray (B) opens.  
67  
 
3. Grab handle part of front cover and pull out cassette until it stops.  
4. Use the right paper guide (C) to slide both paper guides all the way out.  
5. Load paper stack in portrait orientation WITH PRINT SIDE FACING DOWN, and place it in  
center of cassette.  
Push the paper stack all the way to the back of the cassette.  
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
Important  
• Always load paper in portrait orientation (D). Loading paper in landscape orientation (E) can  
cause paper jams.  
68  
6. Slide the right paper guide (C) to align the paper guides with both sides of the paper stack.  
Do not slide the paper guides too hard against the paper. The paper may not be fed properly.  
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
Note  
• Do not load sheets of paper higher than the load limit mark (F).  
• Keep the paper stack height below the tabs (G) of the paper guides.  
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
7. Grab right and left sides of front cover and push cassette back until arrow ( ) on front  
cover is aligned with edge of printer.  
After pushing the cassette back properly, the paper information registration screen appears on the LCD.  
69  
8. Press the OK button.  
9. Use the  
OK button.  
button to select the size of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the  
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
10. Use the  
button to select Plain paper and press the OK button.  
Follow the instructions of any messages displayed to register the paper information.  
11. Pull the paper output support (H) out from the paper output tray.  
12. Open the output tray extension (I).  
70  
Note  
• There are various types of paper, such as paper with a special surface coating for printing photos at  
optimal quality and paper suitable for documents. Each media type has specific preset settings (how ink  
is used and sprayed, distance from nozzles, etc.), that allow you to print to that type with optimal image  
quality. The wrong paper settings may cause poor printout color quality or scratches on the printed  
surface. If you notice blurring or uneven colors, increase the print quality setting and try printing again.  
• To prevent incorrect printing, this printer has a function that detects whether the information set for the  
paper loaded matches the paper settings. Before printing, make paper settings in accordance with the  
paper information. When this function is enabled, an error message is displayed if these settings do not  
match to prevent incorrect printing. When this error message is displayed, check and correct the paper  
settings.  
71  
Loading Photo Paper  
You can load photo paper.  
Important  
• If you cut plain paper to a size of 5" x 7" (13 x 18 cm) or smaller to perform a trial print, it may cause a  
paper jam.  
Note  
• We recommend Canon genuine photo paper for printing photos.  
For details on the Canon genuine paper, see Supported Media Types.  
1. Prepare paper.  
Align the edges of paper. If paper is curled, flatten it.  
Note  
• Align the edges of paper neatly before loading. Loading paper without aligning the edges may  
cause paper jams.  
• If paper is curled, hold the curled corners and gently bend them in the opposite direction until the  
paper becomes completely flat.  
Check3  
For details on how to flatten curled paper, see  
• When using Photo Paper Plus Semi-gloss SG-201, even if the sheet is curled, load one sheet at a  
time as it is. If you roll up this paper to flatten, this may cause cracks on the surface of the paper  
and reduce the print quality.  
2. Open the front cover (A) gently.  
The paper output tray (B) opens.  
72  
 
3. Grab handle part of front cover and pull out cassette until it stops.  
4. Use the right paper guide (C) to slide both paper guides all the way out.  
5. Load paper stack in portrait orientation WITH PRINT SIDE FACING DOWN, and place it in  
center of cassette.  
Push the paper stack all the way to the back of the cassette.  
73  
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
Important  
• Always load paper in portrait orientation (D). Loading paper in landscape orientation (E) can  
cause paper jams.  
6. Slide the right paper guide (C) to align the paper guides with both sides of the paper stack.  
Do not slide the paper guides too hard against the paper. The paper may not be fed properly.  
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
Note  
• Do not load sheets of paper higher than the load limit mark (F).  
• Keep the paper stack height below the tabs (G) of the paper guides.  
74  
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
• Load small size paper, such as 4" x 6" (10 x 15 cm), by pushing it in all the way to the back of the  
cassette.  
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
7. Grab right and left sides of front cover and push cassette back until arrow ( ) on front  
cover is aligned with edge of printer.  
After pushing the cassette back properly, the printer makes an electronic sound and the paper  
information registration screen is displayed on the LCD.  
75  
8. Press the OK button.  
9. Use the  
OK button.  
button to select the size of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the  
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
10. Use the  
OK button.  
button to select the type of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the  
Follow the instructions of any messages displayed to register the paper information.  
11. Pull the paper output support (H) out from the paper output tray.  
12. Open the output tray extension (I).  
76  
Note  
• There are various types of paper, such as paper with a special surface coating for printing photos at  
optimal quality and paper suitable for documents. Each media type has specific preset settings (how ink  
is used and sprayed, distance from nozzles, etc.), that allow you to print to that type with optimal image  
quality. The wrong paper settings may cause poor printout color quality or scratches on the printed  
surface. If you notice blurring or uneven colors, increase the print quality setting and try printing again.  
• To prevent incorrect printing, this printer has a function that detects whether the information set for the  
paper loaded matches the paper settings. Before printing, make paper settings in accordance with the  
paper information. When this function is enabled, an error message is displayed if these settings do not  
match to prevent incorrect printing. When this error message is displayed, check and correct the paper  
settings.  
77  
Loading Envelopes  
The address is automatically rotated and printed according to the envelope's direction by specifying with  
your computer properly.  
Important  
• Printing of envelopes from the operation panel is not supported.  
• Do not use the following envelopes. They could jam in the printer or cause the printer to malfunction.  
• Envelopes with an embossed or treated surface  
• Envelopes with a double flap  
• Envelopes whose gummed flaps are already moistened and adhesive  
1. Prepare envelopes.  
• Press down on all four corners and edges of the envelopes to flatten them.  
• If the envelopes are curled, hold the opposite corners and gently twist them in the opposite  
direction.  
• If the corner of the envelope flap is folded, flatten it.  
• Use a pen to press the leading edge in the inserting direction flat and sharpen the crease.  
The figures above show a side view of the leading edge of the envelope.  
Important  
• The envelopes may jam in the printer if they are not flat or the edges are not aligned. Make sure  
that no curl or puff exceeds 0.12 inch (3 mm).  
2. Open the front cover (A) gently.  
The paper output tray (B) opens.  
78  
 
3. Grab handle part of front cover and pull out cassette until it stops.  
4. Use the right paper guide (C) to slide both paper guides all the way out.  
5. Load the envelopes in the center of the cassette WITH THE PRINT SIDE FACING DOWN.  
Fold flap of the envelope and load the envelope in portrait orientation with the address side facing down.  
Push the envelopes all the way to the back of the cassette. Up to 5 envelopes can be loaded at once.  
79  
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
6. Slide the right paper guide (C) to align both paper guides with both sides of the envelopes.  
Do not slide the paper guides too hard against the envelopes. The envelopes may not be fed properly.  
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
Note  
• Do not load envelopes higher than the load limit mark (D).  
• Keep the envelope stack height below the tabs (E) of the paper guides.  
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
7. Grab right and left sides of front cover and push cassette back until arrow ( ) on front  
cover is aligned with edge of printer.  
After pushing the cassette back properly, the paper information registration screen appears on the LCD.  
80  
8. Press the OK button.  
9. Use  
button to select size of loaded envelopes in cassette and press OK button.  
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
10. Use  
button to select Envelope and press OK button.  
Follow the instructions of any messages displayed to register the paper information.  
11. Pull the paper output support (F) out from the paper output tray.  
12. Open the output tray extension (G).  
81  
Note  
• To prevent incorrect printing, this printer has a function that detects whether the information set for the  
paper loaded matches the paper settings. Before printing, make paper settings in accordance with the  
paper information. When this function is enabled, an error message is displayed if these settings do not  
match to prevent incorrect printing. When this error message is displayed, check and correct the paper  
settings.  
82  
Where to Load Originals  
The printer has two positions to load originals: platen and ADF (Auto Document Feeder).  
Select the position to load the original according to the size, type, or usage.  
Note  
• For details on the supported originals, see below.  
Loading Documents, Photos, or Book on Platen  
Loading Two or More Sheets of Document of the Same Size and  
Thickness in the ADF  
You can also load a sheet of document in the ADF.  
Note  
• To scan the original at optimum quality, load it on the platen.  
84  
 
Loading Originals on Platen  
1. Open the document cover.  
2. Load original WITH SIDE TO SCAN FACING DOWN on platen.  
Important  
• Be sure to observe the following when loading the original on the platen.  
Failure to observe the following may cause the scanner to malfunction or the platen glass to  
break.  
• Do not place any objects weighing 4.4 lb (2.0 kg) or more on the platen glass.  
• Do not put any pressure of 4.4 lb (2.0 kg) or more on the platen glass, such as pressing down  
the original.  
3. Close the document cover gently.  
85  
 
Important  
• After loading the original on the platen, be sure to close the document cover before starting to copy, fax,  
or scan.  
86  
Loading Documents in the ADF (Auto Document Feeder)  
Note  
• To scan a document at optimum quality, load it on the platen.  
1. Make sure any original has been removed from platen.  
2. Open document tray (A).  
3. Slide the paper guides (B) all the way out.  
4. Load document WITH SIDE TO SCAN FACING UP in document tray.  
Insert the document until it stops.  
Note  
• For details on the supported originals, see below.  
5. Adjust document guide (B) to match width of document.  
Do not slide the document guide too hard against the document. The document may not be fed properly.  
87  
 
88  
Loading Based on Use  
Load the original in the correct position according to the function to use. If you do not load the original  
correctly, it may not be scanned properly.  
Originals  
Function  
Copying or Faxing  
How to Load  
Magazines, Newspapers, and  
Documents  
Scanning by detecting the type and  
size of the original automatically  
If you scan using the operation panel,  
press the SCAN button and select Auto  
scan for Document type.  
Scanning by specifying a standard  
size (A4, Letter, etc.)  
If you scan using the operation panel,  
press the SCAN button, select Docu-  
ment or Photo for Document type, and  
then specify a standard size (A4, Letter,  
etc.) for Scan size.  
Photos, Postcards, Business  
Cards, and Disc (BD/DVD/CD)  
Scanning only one original  
If you scan using the operation panel, fol-  
low the operation below.  
• Press the SCAN button and select  
Auto scan for Document type.  
• Press the SCAN button, select Photo  
for Document type, and then specify  
Auto scan(A) -Singl for Scan size.  
Scanning two or more originals  
If you scan using the operation panel, fol-  
low the operation below.  
• Press the SCAN button and select  
Auto scan for Document type.  
• Press the SCAN button, select Photo  
for Document type, and then specify  
Auto scan(A) -Multi for Scan size.  
Note  
• For details on how to scan from the computer and how to load originals, see below.  
• For Windows:  
Scanning from Computer (Windows)  
• For macOS:  
89  
 
Loading the Original to Be Aligned with the alignment mark  
Place the original WITH THE SIDE TO SCAN FACING DOWN on the platen and align it with the  
alignment mark  
. Portions placed on the diagonally striped area cannot be scanned.  
Important  
• The printer cannot scan the striped area (A) (0.04 inch (1 mm) from the edges of the platen glass).  
Loading Only One Original in Center of Platen  
Place the original WITH THE SIDE TO SCAN FACING DOWN, with 0.40 inch (1 cm) or more space  
between the edges (diagonally striped area) of the platen. Portions placed on the diagonally striped area  
cannot be scanned.  
90  
   
Loading Two or More Originals on Platen  
Place the originals WITH THE SIDE TO SCAN FACING DOWN. Allow 0.40 inch (1 cm) or more space  
between the edges (diagonally striped area) of the platen and the originals, and between the originals.  
Portions placed on the diagonally striped area cannot be scanned.  
You can place up to 12 items.  
B: More than 0.40 inch (1 cm)  
Note  
• The Skew Correction function automatically compensates for the originals placed at an angle of up to  
approximately 10 degrees. Slanted photos with a long edge of 7.1 inches (180 mm) or more cannot  
be corrected.  
• Non-rectangular or irregular shaped photos (such as cut out photos) may not be scanned properly.  
91  
 
Supported Originals  
Platen  
Item  
Details  
Types of originals  
• Text document, magazine, or newspaper  
• Printed photo, postcard, business card, or disc (BD/DVD/CD, etc.)  
• Documents that are not suitable for the ADF  
Size (width x height)  
Quantity  
Max. 8.5 x 11.7 inches (216 x 297 mm)  
One or more sheets*  
Thickness  
Max. 0.2 inch (5 mm)  
* Two or more originals can be loaded on the platen depending on the selected function.  
In the ADF (Auto Document Feeder)  
Item  
Kind of original  
Size  
Details  
Plain-paper documents with multiple pages of the same size, thickness, and weight  
A4, Letter, Legal  
Duplex copying or 2-on-1/4-on-1 copying: A4/Letter only  
2
Quantity  
• A4/Letter: Max. 20 sheets (20 lb. (75 g /m ) paper), up to 0.08 inch (2 mm) high  
2
• Legal: Max. 5 sheets (20 lb. (75 g /m ) paper), up to 0.02 inch (0.5 mm) high  
Thickness  
Weight  
0.003 to 0.005 inch (0.07 to 0.13 mm)  
2
16.0 to 25.3 lb. (60 to 95 g /m )  
Note  
• Make sure any liquids on documents, such as glue, ink, or correction fluid are dry before loading.  
Do not load glued documents in the ADF, even if the glue is dry, because this may cause paper jams.  
• Remove all staples, paper clips, or other fasteners before feeding documents.  
• Load Legal-sized documents in the ADF.  
• Do not load these kinds of documents in the ADF, which may cause paper jams.  
• Wrinkled or creased documents  
• Curled documents  
• Torn documents  
• Documents with holes  
• Glued documents  
• Documents with sticky notes  
92  
 
• Documents on carbon paper  
• Documents on coated paper  
• Documents on onion skin or other thin paper  
• Photos or excessively thick documents  
93  
Replacing a FINE Cartridge  
When remaining ink cautions or errors occur, the error message will appear on the LCD to inform you of the  
error. In this state, the printer cannot print or scan. Check the error message and take appropriate action.  
While using the printer, the periphery of the paper output slot may become dirty with ink.  
Before replacing the FINE Cartridge, clean the periphery of the paper output slot.  
Replacing Procedure  
When you need to replace a FINE cartridge, follow the procedure below.  
Important  
• Do not touch the electrical contacts (A) or print head nozzle (B) on a FINE cartridge. The printer may  
not print properly if you touch them.  
• If you remove a FINE cartridge, replace it immediately. Do not leave the printer with the FINE  
cartridge removed.  
• Use a new FINE cartridge for replacement. Installing a used FINE cartridge may cause the nozzles to  
clog.  
Furthermore, with such a FINE cartridge, the printer will not be able to inform you when to replace the  
FINE cartridge properly.  
• Once a FINE cartridge has been installed, do not remove it from the printer and leave it out in the  
open. This will cause the FINE cartridge to dry out, and the printer may not operate properly when it  
is reinstalled. To maintain optimal printing quality, use a FINE cartridge within six months of first use.  
Note  
• For Windows, if a FINE cartridge runs out of ink, you can print with either color or black FINE  
cartridge, in whichever ink remains, only for a while. However the print quality may be reduced  
compared to when printing with both cartridges. We recommend to use a new FINE cartridge in order  
to obtain optimum qualities.  
Even when printing with one ink only, print with leaving the empty FINE cartridge installed. If either of  
the color FINE cartridge or black FINE cartridge is not installed, an error occurs and the printer  
cannot print.  
For information on how to configure this setting, see below.  
95  
   
Setting the FINE Cartridge to be Used  
• Color ink may be consumed even when printing a black-and-white document or when black-and-  
white printing is specified.  
Both color ink and black ink are also consumed in the standard cleaning and deep cleaning of the  
print head, which may be necessary to maintain the performance of the printer. When ink runs out,  
replace the FINE cartridge immediately with a new one.  
2. Open front cover (C).  
The paper output tray (D) opens.  
Note  
• Remove any paper in the cassette.  
3. Open the paper output cover.  
The FINE cartridge holder (E) moves to the replacement position.  
Caution  
• Do not hold the FINE cartridge holder to stop or move it forcibly. Do not touch the FINE  
cartridge holder until it stops completely.  
96  
Important  
• The inside of the printer may be stained with ink. Be careful not to stain your hands or clothing  
when replacing the FINE cartridge. You can easily wipe off the ink from the inside of the printer  
with tissue paper or the like.  
• Do not touch the metallic parts or other parts inside the printer.  
• If the paper output cover is left open for more than 10 minutes, the FINE cartridge holder may  
move and the Alarm lamp may light. In this case, close the paper output cover, and then open it  
again.  
4. Remove the empty FINE cartridge.  
1. Push down the FINE cartridge until it clicks.  
2. Remove the FINE cartridge.  
Important  
• Handle the FINE cartridge carefully to avoid staining of clothing or the surrounding area.  
• Discard the empty FINE cartridge according to the local laws and regulations regarding disposal  
of consumables.  
5. Prepare a new FINE cartridge.  
1. Take new FINE cartridge out of its package and remove protective tape (F) gently.  
97  
Important  
• If you shake a FINE cartridge, ink may spill out and stain your hands and the surrounding area.  
Handle a FINE cartridge carefully.  
• Be careful not to stain your hands and the surrounding area with ink on the removed protective  
tape.  
• Do not reattach the protective tape once you have removed it. Discard it according to the local  
laws and regulations regarding disposal of consumables.  
• Do not touch the electrical contacts or print head nozzle on a FINE cartridge. The printer may  
not print properly if you touch them.  
6. Install the FINE cartridge.  
1. Insert the new FINE cartridge at a slant into the FINE cartridge holder.  
The color FINE cartridge should be installed into the left slot and the black FINE cartridge should be  
installed into the right slot.  
Important  
• Insert the FINE cartridge gently so that it does not hit the electrical contacts on the FINE cartridge  
holder.  
98  
2. Push the FINE cartridge in and up firmly until it snaps into place.  
Important  
• Check if the FINE cartridge is installed correctly.  
99  
• The printer cannot print unless both the color FINE cartridge and black FINE cartridge are  
installed. Be sure to install both cartridges.  
7. Close the paper output cover.  
Note  
• If the error message appears on the LCD after the paper output cover is closed, take  
appropriate action.  
• When you start printing after replacing the FINE cartridge, the printer starts cleaning the print  
head automatically. Do not perform any other operations until the printer completes the cleaning  
of the print head.  
• If the print head is out of alignment, as indicated by misaligned printed ruled lines or similar  
• The printer may make noise during operation.  
100  
Checking Ink Status on the LCD  
2. Press Setup button, use  
button to select Ink information, and then press OK button.  
3. Make sure Remaining ink appears and press OK button.  
A in the figure below shows remaining ink level.  
Example:  
The ink is running low. Prepare a new ink cartridge.  
The resulting print quality may not be satisfactory, if printing is continued under this condition.  
Note  
• You can also check the ink status on the LCD when you press the COPY or FAX button. The  
current remaining ink level will be displayed on the LCD for a few seconds.  
• You can also check the ink status on the computer screen.  
• For Windows:  
Checking Ink Status from Your Computer  
• For macOS:  
101  
 
Ink Tips  
How is ink used for various purposes other than printing?  
Ink may be used for purposes other than printing. Ink is not only used for printing, but also for cleaning the  
print head to maintain the optimal printing quality.  
The printer has the function to automatically clean the ink jet nozzles to prevent clogging. In the cleaning  
procedure, used ink for nozzle cleaning is limited to a small amount.  
Does black-and-white printing use color ink?  
Black-and-white printing may use ink other than black ink depending on the type of printing paper or the  
settings of the printer driver. So, color ink is consumed even when printing in black-and-white.  
102  
 
Maintenance Procedure  
If print results are blurred, colors are not printed correctly, or print results are unsatisfactory (e.g. misaligned  
printed ruled lines), perform the maintenance procedure below.  
Important  
• Do not rinse or wipe the FINE cartridge. This can cause trouble with the FINE cartridge.  
Note  
• Check if ink remains in the FINE cartridge.  
• Check if the FINE cartridge is installed correctly.  
Also check if the protective tape on the bottom of the FINE cartridge is removed.  
• If an error message appears on the LCD, see An Error Occurs.  
• For Windows, increasing the print quality in the printer driver settings may improve the print result.  
Changing the Print Quality and Correcting Image Data  
When the Print Results Are Blurred or Uneven:  
Step1  
Print the nozzle check pattern.  
From the printer  
From the computer  
• For Windows:  
Printing a Nozzle Check Pattern  
• For macOS:  
Printing a Nozzle Check Pattern  
Step2  
104  
   
If there are missing lines or horizontal white streaks in the pattern:  
Step3  
Clean the print head.  
From the printer  
From the computer  
• For Windows:  
Cleaning the Print Heads  
• For macOS:  
After cleaning the print head, print and examine the nozzle check pattern:  
If the problem is not resolved after performing from step 1 to step 3 twice:  
Step4  
Clean the print head deeply.  
From the printer  
From the computer  
• For Windows:  
Cleaning the Print Heads  
• For macOS:  
If the problem is not resolved, turn off the power and clean the print head deeply again after 24 hours. Do not  
unplug the power cord when turning off the power.  
If the problem is still not resolved:  
Step5  
Replace the FINE cartridge.  
Note  
• If the problem is still not resolved after replacing the FINE cartridge, contact your nearest Canon  
service center to request a repair.  
105  
When the Print Results Are Not Even such as the Ruled Lines Are  
Misaligned:  
Step  
Align the print head.  
From the printer  
From the computer  
• For Windows:  
Adjusting Print Head Position Automatically  
• For macOS:  
106  
Printing the Nozzle Check Pattern  
Print the nozzle check pattern to determine whether the ink ejects properly from the print head nozzle.  
Note  
• If the remaining ink level is low, the nozzle check pattern will not be printed correctly. Replace the FINE  
Cartridge whose ink is low.  
You need to prepare: a sheet of A4 or Letter-sized plain paper  
2. Load a sheet of A4 or Letter-sized plain paper in the cassette.  
After pushing the cassette back, the paper information registration screen is displayed on the LCD.  
Select A4 or Letter for Size: and Plain paper for Type: and then press the OK button.  
3. Pull the paper output support out from the paper output tray, then open the output tray  
extension.  
4. Press the Setup button, use the  
button to select Maintenance, and press the OK  
button.  
5. Use the  
button to select Nozzle check and press the OK button.  
The nozzle check pattern will be printed.  
Do not perform any other operations until the printer completes the printing of the nozzle check pattern.  
107  
 
Examining the Nozzle Check Pattern  
Examine the nozzle check pattern, and clean the print head if necessary.  
1. Check if there are missing lines in the pattern A or horizontal white streaks in the pattern B.  
If there are missing lines in the pattern A:  
C: Good  
D: Bad (lines are missing)  
If there are horizontal white streaks in the pattern B:  
E: Good  
F: Bad (horizontal white streaks are present)  
If any color in the pattern A or the pattern B is not printed:  
(Example: Magenta pattern is not printed)  
108  
 
Cleaning the Print Head  
Clean the print head if lines are missing or if horizontal white streaks are present in the printed nozzle check  
pattern. Cleaning unclogs the nozzles and restores the print head condition. Cleaning the print head  
consumes ink, so clean the print head only when necessary.  
2. Press the Setup button, use the  
button to select Maintenance, and press the OK  
button.  
3. Use the  
button to select Cleaning and then press the OK button.  
The printer starts cleaning the print head.  
Do not perform any other operations until the printer completes the cleaning of the print head. This takes  
about 1 minute.  
Note  
• If the problem is not resolved after cleaning the print head twice, clean the print head deeply.  
109  
 
Deep Print Head Cleaning  
If print quality does not improve by the standard cleaning of the print head, clean the print head deeply.  
Cleaning the print head deeply consumes more ink than the standard cleaning of the print head, so clean  
the print head deeply only when necessary.  
2. Press the Setup button, use the  
button to select Maintenance, and press the OK  
button.  
3. Use the  
button to select Deep cleaning and then press the OK button.  
The printer starts cleaning the print head deeply.  
Do not perform any other operations until the printer completes the deep cleaning of the print head. This  
takes about 1 minute.  
If the problem is not resolved, turn off the power and clean the print head deeply again after 24 hours. Do  
not unplug the power cord when turning off the power.  
If the problem is still not resolved, replace the FINE cartridge with a new one. If the problem is still not  
resolved after replacing the FINE cartridge, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.  
110  
 
Aligning the Print Head  
If printed ruled lines are misaligned or print results are otherwise unsatisfactory, adjust the print head  
position.  
Note  
• If the remaining ink level is low, the print head alignment sheet will not be printed correctly.  
Replace the FINE cartridge whose ink is low.  
You need to prepare: a sheet of A4 or Letter-sized plain paper  
2. Load a sheet of A4 or Letter-sized plain paper in the cassette.  
After pushing the cassette back, the paper information registration screen is displayed on the LCD.  
Select A4 or Letter for Size: and Plain paper for Type: and then press the OK button.  
3. Pull the paper output support out from the paper output tray, then open the output tray  
extension.  
4. Press the Setup button, use the  
button to select Maintenance, and press the OK  
button.  
5. Use the  
button to select Head alignment and then press the OK button.  
The print head alignment sheet will be printed.  
111  
 
Important  
• Do not touch any printed part on the print head alignment sheet. If the sheet is stained or wrinkled,  
it may not be scanned properly.  
• If the print head alignment sheet was not printed correctly, press the Stop button, and redo this  
procedure from the beginning.  
6. Check message and place print head alignment sheet on platen.  
Place the print head alignment sheet WITH THE PRINTED SIDE FACING DOWN and align the mark  
on the upper left corner of the sheet with the alignment mark  
.
112  
Note  
• The print head alignment sheet cannot be scanned if it is loaded in the ADF (Auto Document  
Feeder).  
7. Close the document cover gently, then press the Black button or the Color button.  
The printer starts scanning the print head alignment sheet, and the print head position will be adjusted  
automatically.  
After the print head position adjustment completion message is displayed, remove the print head  
alignment sheet on the platen.  
Important  
• Do not open the document cover or move the print head alignment sheet on the platen until  
adjusting the print head position is complete.  
• If the error message appears on the LCD, press the OK button to release the error, then take  
appropriate action.  
Note  
• For Windows, when the print results are still not satisfactory after adjusting the print head position as  
described above, adjust the print head position manually from the computer.  
Adjusting Print Head Position Manually  
• To print and check the current head position adjustment values, select Print align value from the  
Maintenance screen.  
113  
Opening Remote UI for Maintenance  
You can perform maintenance of printer and change the settings from a Remote UI.  
The following is the procedure to open a Remote UI.  
1. Open System Preferences, and select Printers & Scanners  
2. Select your model from the printer list, and click Options & Supplies...  
3. Click Show Printer Webpage... in General tab  
Remote UI starts.  
Note  
• The password may have to be entered after Remote UI starts. In such a case, enter the password  
and click OK. In case you do not know the password, click About password and cookies.  
Related Topics  
Printing a Nozzle Check Pattern  
Reducing the Printer Noise  
115  
 
Cleaning the Print Heads  
The print head cleaning function allows you to clear up clogged print head nozzle. Perform print head  
cleaning if printing is faint or a specific color fails to print, even though there is enough ink.  
Cleaning  
1. Select Utilities from Remote UI  
2. Click Cleaning  
Before running the cleaning, check the following items:  
Check whether the printer is on and open the printer's paper output cover.  
Check the following items for each ink. Then, if necessary, perform Cleaning.  
• Did you push in the ink cartridge completely until you heard a clicking sound?  
• If the orange tape is there, has it been peeled off completely?  
Any remaining tape will hinder ink output.  
• Did you install the ink cartridges in their correct positions?  
3. Execute cleaning  
Click Yes.  
Print head cleaning starts.  
4. Complete cleaning  
Next, the message for nozzle check pattern printing is displayed.  
5. Check the results  
To check whether the print quality has improved, click Yes. To cancel the check process, click No.  
If cleaning the head once does not resolve the print head problem, clean it once more.  
Important  
Cleaning consumes a small amount of ink.  
Cleaning the print head frequently will rapidly deplete your printer's ink supply. Consequently, perform  
cleaning only when necessary.  
Deep cleaning  
Deep cleaning is more thorough than cleaning. Perform deep cleaning when two Cleaning attempts do  
not resolve the print head problem.  
1. Select Utilities from Remote UI  
116  
 
2. Click Deep cleaning  
Before running the deep cleaning, check the following items:  
Check whether the printer is on and open the printer's paper output cover.  
Check the following items for each ink. Then, if necessary, perform Deep cleaning.  
• Did you push in the ink cartridge completely until you heard a clicking sound?  
• If the orange tape is there, has it been peeled off completely?  
Any remaining tape will hinder ink output.  
• Did you install the ink cartridges in their correct positions?  
3. Execute deep cleaning  
Click Yes.  
Print head deep cleaning starts.  
4. Complete deep cleaning  
Next, the message for nozzle check pattern printing is displayed.  
5. Check the results  
To check whether the print quality has improved, click Yes. To cancel the check process, click No.  
Important  
Deep cleaning consumes a larger amount of ink than Cleaning.  
Cleaning the print head frequently will rapidly deplete your printer's ink supply. Consequently, perform  
cleaning only when necessary.  
Note  
• If there is no sign of improvement after Deep cleaning, turn off the printer, wait 24 hours, and then  
perform Deep cleaning again. If there is still no sign of improvement, see "Ink Does Not Come Out."  
Related Topic  
Printing a Nozzle Check Pattern  
117  
Adjusting Print Head Position  
Any error in the print head installation position can cause color and line shifts. Adjusting the print head  
position improves print results.  
Auto head alignment  
1. Select Utilities from Remote UI  
2. Click Auto head alignment  
A message appears.  
3. Load paper in printer  
In the cassette, load 1 sheet of plain A4-sized or Letter-sized paper.  
4. Run head position adjustment  
Check that the printer power is on, and then click Yes.  
Head alignment starts. Proceed with the operations in accordance with the messages on the screen.  
Important  
• Do not open the paper output cover while printing is in progress; otherwise, printing will stop.  
Note  
• You can print and check the current settings by clicking on Print the head alignment value.  
118  
 
Checking Ink Status from Your Computer  
You can check the detailed information such as the remaining ink level and the FINE cartridge types of your  
model.  
If you select Printer status from Remote UI, the ink status appears as an illustration.  
Estimated ink levels  
You can check the types and levels of ink.  
When ink levels are running low or an error occurs because there is no ink, a notification icon will  
appear.  
Ink number  
You can look up the correct FINE cartridge for your printer.  
Note  
• To check the ink status, you can also display the pop-up menu of the Print dialog and select Supply  
Levels.  
119  
 
Cleaning  
Cleaning Exterior Surfaces  
Cleaning Platen and Document Cover  
Cleaning the ADF (Auto Document Feeder)  
120  
 
Cleaning Paper Feed Rollers  
If the paper feed roller is dirty or paper powder is attached to it, paper may not be fed properly.  
In this case, clean the paper feed roller. Cleaning will wear out the paper feed roller, so perform this only  
when necessary.  
You need to prepare: a sheet of A4 or Letter-sized plain paper or cleaning sheet available on the  
market  
2. Remove any paper from the cassette, then push it back.  
Note  
• If a message is displayed on the screen after pushing the cassette back, press the OK button.  
3. Press the Setup button, use the  
button to select Maintenance, and press the OK  
button.  
4. Clean the paper feed rollers without paper.  
1. Use the  
button to select Roller cleaning and then press the OK button.  
The paper feed roller will rotate as it is cleaned without paper.  
5. Clean the paper feed rollers with paper.  
1. Make sure that the paper feed rollers have stopped rotating, then load a sheet of A4 or Letter-  
sized plain paper or cleaning sheet available on the market in cassette.  
After pushing the cassette back, the paper information registration screen appears on the LCD. Select A4  
or Letter for Size: and Plain paper for Type: and then press the OK button.  
2. Pull out the paper output support from the paper output tray, then open the output tray  
extension.  
3. Make sure that Roller cleaning is selected, then press the OK button.  
The printer starts cleaning. The cleaning will be complete when the paper is ejected.  
121  
 
If the problem is not resolved after cleaning the paper feed roller, contact your nearest Canon service center  
to request a repair.  
122  
Cleaning Inside the Printer (Bottom Plate Cleaning)  
Remove stains from the inside of the printer. If the inside of the printer becomes dirty, printed paper may get  
dirty, so we recommend performing cleaning regularly.  
You need to prepare: a sheet of A4 or Letter-sized plain paper*  
* Be sure to use a new piece of paper.  
1. Make sure that the power is turned on, then remove any paper from the cassette.  
2. Prepare paper.  
1. Fold a single sheet of A4 or Letter-sized plain paper in half widthwise, then unfold the paper.  
2. Fold one side of the opened paper in another half, aligning the edge with the center crease,  
and then unfold the paper.  
3. Load only this sheet of paper in the cassette with the ridges of the creases facing up and the  
edge of the half with no crease facing to the far side.  
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.  
After pushing the cassette back, the paper information registration screen is displayed on the LCD. Select  
A4 or Letter for Size: and Plain paper for Type: and then press the OK button.  
4. Pull the paper output support out from the paper output tray, then open the output tray  
extension.  
123  
 
3. Press the Setup button, use the  
button to select Maintenance, and press the OK  
button.  
4. Use the  
button to select Bottom cleaning and then press the OK button.  
The paper cleans the inside of the printer as it feeds through the printer.  
Check the folded parts of the ejected paper. If they are smudged with ink, perform Bottom Plate Cleaning  
again.  
Note  
• When performing Bottom Plate Cleaning again, be sure to use a new piece of paper.  
If the problem is not resolved after performing cleaning again, the protrusions inside the printer may be  
stained. Wipe off any ink from the protrusions using a cotton swab or the like.  
Important  
• Before cleaning the printer, turn it off and unplug it.  
• The power cannot be turned off while the printer is sending or receiving a fax, or when unsent faxes  
are stored in the printer's memory. Make sure the printer has finished sending or receiving faxes  
before turning it off.  
• Remember that faxes cannot be sent or received while the printer is off.  
• Unplugging the printer will reset the date/time setting and erase all documents in the printer's  
memory. Send faxes or print documents as needed before unplugging the printer.  
124  
Safety Precautions  
Safety Precautions  
• This manual contains important notices and safety precautions about your printer.  
Do not use the printer in ways other than described in the accompanying manuals, as this may result  
in fire, electric shock or other unexpected accidents.  
Safety standard marks and declarations are only valid for the supported voltages and frequencies in  
the applicable countries or regions.  
Warning  
• Users with cardiac pacemakers:  
This product emits a low-level magnetic flux. If you feel abnormalities, please move away from the  
product and consult your doctor.  
• Do not use the printer in the following cases:  
Stop use immediately, unplug the printer and call your local service representative to request repair.  
• Metal objects or liquids are spilt inside the printer.  
• The printer emits smoke, strange odors, or makes unusual noises.  
• The power cord or plug overheat or are broken, bent or damaged in any way.  
• Failure to adhere to the following may result in fire, electric shock, or injury:  
• Do not place product close to the flammable solvents such as alcohol or thinner.  
• Do not open or modify the printer.  
• Use only the power cord/cables that came with your printer. Do not use these cables with other  
devices.  
• Do not plug in to voltages or frequencies other than those specified.  
• Plug the power cord into the socket completely.  
• Do not plug in or unplug the power cord with wet hands.  
• Do not damage the power cord by twisting, bundling, tying, pulling or excessively bending it.  
• Do not place heavy objects on the power cord.  
• Do not connect multiple power cords to a single electrical outlet. Do not use multiple extension  
cords.  
• Do not leave the printer plugged in during lightning storms.  
• Always unplug the power cord and cables when cleaning. Do not use flammable sprays or liquids  
such as alcohol or thinners for cleaning.  
• Unplug the power cord once a month to check that it is not overheating, rusted, bent, scratched,  
split, or otherwise damaged.  
Caution  
• Do not put your hands inside the printer while printing.  
• Do not touch the print head or other metal parts immediately after printing.  
• Ink  
• Keep ink out of reach of children.  
• If ink is accidentally licked or swallowed, rinse out your mouth and drink one or two glasses of  
water. If irritation or discomfort occurs, obtain medical advice immediately.  
127  
 
• In case ink gets in contact with eyes, rinse with water immediately. In case ink gets in contact  
with skin, wash with soap and water immediately. If irritation to eyes or skin persists, obtain  
medical advice immediately.  
• Moving the printer  
• Do not hold the printer by the cassette. Hold the printer by its sides and carry it with both hands.  
General Notices  
Choosing a Location  
Refer to "Specifications" in the Online manual for details on operating environment.  
• Do not install the printer in a location that is unstable or subject to excessive vibration.  
• Do not install the printer in locations that get very hot (direct sunlight, or close to a heating source),  
very humid or dusty locations, or outdoors.  
• Do not place the printer on a thick rug or carpet.  
• Do not place the printer flush against a wall.  
Power Supply  
• Keep the area around the power outlet clear at all times so you can easily unplug the power cord if  
necessary.  
• Never remove the plug by pulling on the cord.  
128  
General Notices  
• Do not tilt the printer, stand it on end, or turn it upside down. This may cause ink to leak.  
• Do not place anything on top of the printer. Be especially careful to avoid metal objects such as  
paper clips and staples, and containers holding flammable liquids such as alcohol or thinner.  
• Do not apply excessive pressure when placing large objects on the platen glass.  
• Do not attempt to open, disassemble or modify the FINE cartridges. Ink may leak and damage your  
printer.  
• Do not throw FINE cartridges in the fire.  
129  
Regulatory Information  
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS  
SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS  
When using your telephone equipment, basic safety precautions should always be followed to reduce the  
risk of fire, electric shock and injury to persons, including the following:  
1. Do not use this product near water, for example, near a bath tub, wash bowl, kitchen sink or laundry  
tub, in a wet basement or near a swimming pool.  
2. Avoid using this product during an electrical storm. There may be a remote risk of electric shock from  
lightning.  
3. Do not use this product to report a gas leak in the vicinity of the leak.  
"CAUTION - To reduce the risk of fire, use only No. 26 AWG or larger telecommunication line cord."  
IMPORTANTES MESURES DE SÉCURITÉ  
CONSERVER CES INSTRUCTIONS  
Certaines mesures de sécurité doivent être prises pendant l'utilisation de matérial téléphonique afin de  
réduire les risques d'incendie, de choc électrique et de blessures.  
En voice quelquesunes :  
1. Ne pas utiliser l'appareil près de l'eau, p.ex., près d'une baignoire, d'un lavabo, d'un évier de cuisine,  
d'un bac à laver, dans un sous-sol humide ou près d'une piscine.  
2. Éviter d'utiliser l'appareil pendant un orage électrique. Ceci peut présenter un risque de choc  
électrique causé par la foudre.  
3. Ne pas utiliser l'appareil pour signaler une fuite de gaz s'il est situé près de la fuite.  
"ATTENTION - Pour réduire les risques d'incendie, utiliser uniquement des conducteurs de  
télécommunications 26 AWG au de section supérleure."  
Users in the U.S.A.  
FCC Notice (U.S.A. Only)  
For 120V, 60Hz model  
Model Number: K10483 (Contains FCC Approved WLAN Module K30365)  
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference  
received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
Note: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device,  
pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against  
harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio  
frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful  
interference to radio communications.  
However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment  
does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the  
130  
 
equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the  
following measures:  
• Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
• Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.  
• Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is  
connected.  
• Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.  
Use of a shielded cable is required to comply with Class B limits in Subpart B of Part 15 of the FCC Rules.  
Do not make any changes or modifications to the equipment unless otherwise specified in the manual. If  
such changes or modifications should be made, you could be required to stop operation of the equipment.  
FCC ID:AZDK30365  
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the  
user's authority to operate equipment.  
This transmitter must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.  
The equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits for at uncontrolled equipment. This  
equipment should be installed and operated with minimum distance at least 20cm between the radiator  
and persons body (excluding extremities: hands, wrists, feet and ankles) and must not be colocated or  
operated with any other antenna or transmitter.  
Canon U.S.A., Inc.  
One Canon Park  
Melville, New York 11747  
1-800-652-2666  
Interference  
Do not use the printer around medical equipment or other electronic devices. Signals from the printer may  
interfere with the correct operation of these devices.  
Pre-Installation Requirements  
Order Information  
When ordering service from the telephone company for this equipment, the following may be required.  
Universal Service Order Code (USOC): RJ11C  
The Facility Interface Code (FIC): 02LS2  
Service Order Code (SOC): 9.0F  
Connection of the Equipment  
This equipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC rules and the requirements adopted by the ACTA.  
A label on this equipment contains, among other information, a product identifier in the format  
US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. If requested, this number must be provided to the telephone company.  
The REN is used to determine the number of devices that may be connected to a telephone line.  
131  
Excessive RENs on a telephone line may result in the devices not ringing in response to an incoming call.  
In most but not all areas, the sum of RENs should not exceed five (5.0). To be certain of the number of  
devices that may be connected to a line, as determined by the total RENs, contact the local telephone  
company. The REN for this product is part of the product identifier that has the format  
US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. The digits represented by ## are the REN without a decimal point (e.g., 03 is a  
REN of 0.3).  
A plug and jack used to connect this equipment to the premises wiring and telephone network must  
comply with the applicable FCC Part 68 rules and requirements adopted by the ACTA. A compliant  
telephone cord and modular plug is provided with this product. It is designed to be connected to a  
compatible modular jack that is also compliant. See installation instructions for details.  
Connection to party lines is subjected to state tariffs. Contact the state public utility commission, public  
service commission or corporation commission for information.  
If your home has specially wired alarm equipment connected to the telephone line, ensure the installation  
of this equipment does not disable your alarm equipment. If you have questions about what will disable  
alarm equipment, consult your telephone company or a qualified installer.  
In Case of Equipment Malfunction  
Should any malfunction occur which cannot be corrected by the procedures described in the Online  
Manual, disconnect the equipment from the telephone line cable, turn off the power and disconnect the  
power cord. The telephone line cable should not be reconnected or the main power switch turned ON until  
the problem is completely resolved. Users should contact their local authorized Canon Facsimile Service  
Dealer for the servicing of equipment.  
Information regarding Authorized Service Facility locations can be obtained by calling the Canon  
Customer Center.  
Rights of the Telephone Company  
If this equipment causes harm to the telephone network, the telephone company may temporarily  
disconnect service. The telephone company also retains the right to make changes in facilities and  
services that may affect the operation of this equipment. When such changes are necessary, the  
telephone company is required to give adequate prior notice to the user. However, if advance notice is not  
possible, the telephone company will notify the customer as soon as possible. Also, the customer will be  
advised of his/her right to file a compliant with the FCC if he/she believes it is necessary.  
Warning  
The Telephone Consumer Protection Act of 1991 makes it unlawful for any person to use a computer or  
other electronic device to send any message via a telephone FAX machine unless such message clearly  
contains in a margin at the top or bottom of each transmitted page, or on the first page of the  
transmission, the date and time it is sent and an identification of the business or other entity, or other  
individual sending the message and the telephone number of the sending machine or such business,  
other entity, or individual.  
In order to program this information into your FAX machine, you should complete the procedure to register  
your name, unit's telephone number, time, and date. Refer to the Online Manual.  
132  
WEEE (EU&EEA)  
Only for European Union and EEA (Norway, Iceland and Liechtenstein)  
This symbol indicates that this product is not to be disposed of with your household waste, according to  
the WEEE Directive (2012/19/EU) and national legislation. This product should be handed over to a  
designated collection point, e.g., on an authorized one-for-one basis when you buy a new similar product  
or to an authorized collection site for recycling waste electrical and electronic equipment (EEE). Improper  
handling of this type of waste could have a possible negative impact on the environment and human  
health due to potentially hazardous substances that are generally associated with EEE. At the same time,  
your cooperation in the correct disposal of this product will contribute to the effective usage of natural  
resources. For more information about where you can drop off your waste equipment for recycling, please  
contact your local city office, waste authority, approved WEEE scheme or your household waste disposal  
service. For more information regarding return and recycling of WEEE products, please visit www.canon-  
europe.com/weee.  
Nur für Europäische Union und EWR (Norwegen, Island und  
Liechtenstein)  
Dieses Symbol weist darauf hin, dass dieses Produkt gemäß der EU-Richtlinie über Elektro- und  
Elektronik-Altgeräte (2012/19/EU) und nationalen Gesetzen nicht über den Hausmüll entsorgt werden  
darf. Dieses Produkt muss bei einer dafür vorgesehenen Sammelstelle abgegeben werden. Dies kann z.  
B. durch Rückgabe beim Kauf eines ähnlichen Produkts oder durch Abgabe bei einer autorisierten  
Sammelstelle für die Wiederaufbereitung von Elektro- und Elektronik-Altgeräten geschehen. Der  
unsachgemäße Umgang mit Altgeräten kann aufgrund potentiell gefährlicher Stoffe, die generell mit  
Elektro- und Elektronik-Altgeräten in Verbindung stehen, negative Auswirkungen auf die Umwelt und die  
menschliche Gesundheit haben. Durch die umweltgerechte Entsorgung dieses Produkts tragen Sie  
außerdem zu einer effektiven Nutzung natürlicher Ressourcen bei. Informationen zu Sammelstellen für  
Altgeräte erhalten Sie bei Ihrer Stadtverwaltung, dem öffentlich-rechtlichen Entsorgungsträger, einer  
autorisierten Stelle für die Entsorgung von Elektro- und Elektronik-Altgeräten oder Ihrem örtlichen  
Entsorgungsunternehmen. Weitere Informationen zur Rückgabe und Entsorgung von Elektro- und  
Elektronik-Altgeräten finden Sie unter www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Union Européenne, Norvège, Islande et Liechtenstein uniquement.  
133  
 
Ce symbole indique que ce produit ne doit pas être jeté avec les ordures ménagères, conformément à la  
directive DEEE (2012/19/UE) et à la réglementation de votre pays. Ce produit doit être confié au  
distributeur à chaque fois que vous achetez un produit neuf similaire, ou à un point de collecte mis en  
place par les collectivités locales pour le recyclage des Déchets des Équipements Électriques et  
Électroniques (DEEE). Le traitement inapproprié de ce type de déchet risque d'avoir des répercussions  
sur l'environnement et la santé humaine, du fait de la présence de substances potentiellement  
dangereuses généralement associées aux équipements électriques et électroniques. Parallèlement, votre  
entière coopération dans le cadre de la mise au rebut correcte de ce produit favorisera une meilleure  
utilisation des ressources naturelles. Pour plus d'informations sur les points de collecte des équipements  
à recycler, contactez vos services municipaux, les autorités locales compétentes, le plan DEEE approuvé  
ou le service d'enlèvement des ordures ménagères. Pour plus d'informations sur le retour et le recyclage  
des produits DEEE, consultez le site: www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Uitsluitend bestemd voor de Europese Unie en EER (Noorwegen,  
IJsland en Liechtenstein)  
Dit symbool geeft aan dat dit product in overeenstemming met de AEEA-richtlijn (2012/19/EU) en de  
nationale wetgeving niet mag worden afgevoerd met het huishoudelijk afval. Dit product moet worden  
ingeleverd bij een aangewezen, geautoriseerd inzamelpunt, bijvoorbeeld wanneer u een nieuw  
gelijksoortig product aanschaft, of bij een geautoriseerd inzamelpunt voor hergebruik van elektrische en  
elektronische apparatuur (EEA). Een onjuiste afvoer van dit type afval kan leiden tot negatieve effecten op  
het milieu en de volksgezondheid als gevolg van potentieel gevaarlijke stoffen die veel voorkomen in  
elektrische en elektronische apparatuur (EEA). Bovendien werkt u door een juiste afvoer van dit product  
mee aan het effectieve gebruik van natuurlijke hulpbronnen. Voor meer informatie over waar u uw  
afgedankte apparatuur kunt inleveren voor recycling kunt u contact opnemen met het gemeentehuis in uw  
woonplaats, de reinigingsdienst, of het afvalverwerkingsbedrijf. U kunt ook het schema voor de afvoer van  
afgedankte elektrische en elektronische apparatuur (AEEA) raadplegen. Ga voor meer informatie over het  
inzamelen en recyclen van afgedankte elektrische en elektronische apparatuur naar www.canon-  
europe.com/weee.  
Sólo para la Unión Europea y el Área Económica Europea (Noruega,  
Islandia y Liechtenstein)  
Este símbolo indica que este producto no debe desecharse con los desperdicios domésticos, de acuerdo  
con la directiva RAEE (2012/19/UE) y con la legislación nacional. Este producto debe entregarse en uno  
de los puntos de recogida designados, como por ejemplo, entregándolo en el lugar de venta al comprar  
un producto similar o depositándolo en un lugar de recogida autorizado para el reciclado de residuos de  
aparatos eléctricos y electrónicos (RAEE). La manipulación inapropiada de este tipo de desechos podría  
tener un impacto negativo en el entorno y la salud humana, debido a las sustancias potencialmente  
134  
peligrosas que normalmente están asociadas con los RAEE. Al mismo tiempo, su cooperación a la hora  
de desechar correctamente este producto contribuirá a la utilización eficazde los recursos naturales. Para  
más información sobre cómo puede eliminar el equipo para su reciclado, póngase en contacto con las  
autoridades locales, con las autoridades encargadas de los desechos, con un sistema de gestión RAEE  
autorizado o con el servicio de recogida de basuras doméstico. Si desea más información acerca de la  
devolución y reciclado de RAEE, visite la web www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Només per a la Unió Europea i a l’Espai Econòmic Europeu (Noruega,  
Islàndia i Liechtenstein)  
Aquest símbol indica que aquest producte no s’ha de llençar a les escombraries de la llar, d’acord amb la  
Directiva RAEE (2012/19/UE) i la legislació nacional. Aquest producte s’hauria de lliurar en un dels punts  
de recollida designats, com per exemple, intercanviant-lo un per un en comprar un producte similar o  
lliurant-lo en un lloc de recollida autoritzat per al reciclatge de residus d’aparells elèctrics i electrònics  
(AEE). La manipulació inadequada d’aquest tipus de residus podria tenir un impacte negatiu en l’entorn i  
en la salut humana, a causa de les substàncies potencialment perilloses que normalment estan  
associades als AEE. Així mateix, la vostra cooperació a l’hora de llençar correctament aquest producte  
contribuirà a la utilització efectiva dels recursos naturals. Per a més informació sobre els punts on podeu  
lliurar aquest producte per procedir al seu reciclatge, adreceu-vos a la vostra oficina municipal, a les  
autoritats encarregades dels residus, al pla de residus homologat per la RAEE o al servei de recollida de  
deixalles domèstiques de la vostra localitat. Per a més informació sobre la devolució i el reciclatge de  
productes RAEE, visiteu www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Solo per Unione Europea e SEE (Norvegia, Islanda e Liechtenstein)  
Questo simbolo indica che il prodotto deve essere oggetto di raccolta separata in conformità alla Direttiva  
RAEE (2012/19/UE) e alla normativa locale vigente. Il prodotto deve essere smaltito presso un centro di  
raccolta differenziata, un distributore autorizzato che applichi il principio dell'"uno contro uno", ovvero del  
ritiro della vecchia apparecchiatura elettrica al momento dell'acquisto di una nuova, o un impianto  
autorizzato al riciclaggio dei rifiuti di apparecchiature elettriche ed elettroniche. La gestione impropria di  
questo tipo di rifiuti può avere un impatto negativo sull'ambiente e sulla salute umana causato dalle  
sostanze potenzialmente pericolose che potrebbero essere contenute nelle apparecchiature elettriche ed  
elettroniche. Un corretto smaltimento di tali prodotti contribuirà inoltre a un uso efficace delle risorse  
naturali ed eviterà di incorrere nelle sanzioni amministrative di cui all'art. 255 e successivi del Decreto  
Legislativo n. 152/06. Per ulteriori informazioni sullo smaltimento e il recupero dei Rifiuti di  
Apparecchiature Elettriche ed Elettroniche, consultare la Direttiva RAEE, rivolgersi alle autorità  
competenti, oppure visitare il sito www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
135  
Apenas para a União Europeia e AEE (Noruega, Islândia e  
Liechtenstein)  
Este símbolo indica que o produto não deve ser colocado no lixo doméstico, de acordo com a Directiva  
REEE (2012/19/UE) e a legislação nacional. Este produto deverá ser colocado num ponto de recolha  
designado, por exemplo, num local próprio autorizado quando adquirir um produto semelhante novo ou  
num local de recolha autorizado para reciclar resíduos de equipamentos eléctricos e electrónicos (EEE).  
O tratamento inadequado deste tipo de resíduo poderá causar um impacto negativo no ambiente e na  
saúde humana devido às substâncias potencialmente perigosas normalmente associadas aos  
equipamentos eléctricos e electrónicos. Simultaneamente, a sua cooperação no tratamento correcto  
deste produto contribuirá para a utilização eficaz dos recursos naturais. Para mais informações sobre os  
locais onde o equipamento poderá ser reciclado, contacte os serviços locais, a autoridade responsável  
pelos resíduos, o esquema REEE aprovado ou o serviço de tratamento de lixo doméstico. Para mais  
informações sobre a devolução e reciclagem de produtos REEE, vá a www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Gælder kun i Europæiske Union og EØS (Norge, Island og  
Liechtenstein)  
Dette symbol angiver, at det pågældende produkt ikke må bortskaffes sammen med dagrenovation jf.  
direktivet om affald af elektrisk og elektronisk udstyr (WEEE) (2012/19/EU) og gældende national  
lovgivning. Det pågældende produkt skal afleveres på et nærmere specificeret indsamlingssted, f.eks. i  
overensstemmelse med en godkendt én-til-én-procedure, når du indkøber et nyt tilsvarende produkt, eller  
produktet skal afleveres på et godkendt indsamlingssted for elektronikaffald. Forkert håndtering af denne  
type affald kan medføre negative konsekvenser for miljøet og menneskers helbred på grund af de  
potentielt sundhedsskadelige stoffer, der generelt kan forefindes i elektrisk og elektronisk udstyr. Når du  
foretager korrekt bortskaffelse af det pågældende produkt, bidrager du til effektiv brug af  
naturressourcerne. Yderligere oplysninger om, hvor du kan bortskaffe dit elektronikaffald med henblik på  
genanvendelse, får du hos de kommunale renovationsmyndigheder. Yderligere oplysninger om  
returnering og genanvendelse af affald af elektrisk og elektronisk udstyr får du ved at besøge www.canon-  
europe.com/weee.  
Μόνο για την Ευρωπαϊκή Ένωση και τον ΕΟΧ (Νορβηγία, Ισλανδία και  
Λιχτενστάιν)  
136  
Αυτό το σύμβολο υποδηλώνει ότι αυτό το προϊόν δεν πρέπει να απορρίπτεται μαζί με τα οικιακά  
απορρίμματα, σύμφωνα με την Οδηγία σχετικά με τα Απόβλητα Ηλεκτρικού και Ηλεκτρονικού Εξοπλισμού  
(ΑΗΗΕ) (2012/19/ΕΕ) και την εθνική σας νομοθεσία. Αυτό το προϊόν πρέπει να παραδίδεται σε  
καθορισμένο σημείο συλλογής, π.χ. σε μια εξουσιοδοτημένη βάση ανταλλαγής όταν αγοράζετε ένα νέο  
παρόμοιο προϊόν ή σε μια εξουσιοδοτημένη θέση συλλογής για την ανακύκλωση των αποβλήτων  
Ηλεκτρικού και Ηλεκτρονικού Εξοπλισμού (ΗΗΕ). Ο ακατάλληλος χειρισμός αυτού του τύπου αποβλήτων  
μπορεί να έχει αρνητικό αντίκτυπο στο περιβάλλον και την υγεία του ανθρώπου, λόγω δυνητικώς  
επικίνδυνων ουσιών που γενικά συνδέονται με τον ΗΗΕ. Ταυτόχρονα, η συνεργασία σας όσον αφορά τη  
σωστή απόρριψη αυτού του προϊόντος θα συμβάλει στην αποτελεσματική χρήση των φυσικών πόρων.  
Για περισσότερες πληροφορίες σχετικά με τα σημεία όπου μπορείτε να απορρίψετε τον εξοπλισμό σας για  
ανακύκλωση, επικοινωνήστε με το τοπικό γραφείο της πόλης σας, την υπηρεσία απορριμμάτων, το  
εγκεκριμένο σχήμα ΑΗΗΕ ή την υπηρεσία απόρριψης οικιακών αποβλήτων. Για περισσότερες  
πληροφορίες σχετικά με την επιστροφή και την ανακύκλωση των προϊόντων ΑΗΗΕ, επισκεφθείτε την  
τοποθεσία www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Gjelder kun den europeiske union og EØS (Norge, Island og  
Liechtenstein)  
Dette symbolet indikerer at dette produktet ikke skal kastes sammen med husholdningsavfall, i henhold til  
WEEE-direktiv (2012/19/EU) og nasjonal lov. Produktet må leveres til et dertil egnet innsamlingspunkt, det  
vil si på en autorisert en-til-en-basis når du kjøper et nytt lignende produkt, eller til et autorisert  
innsamlingssted for resirkulering av avfall fra elektrisk og elektronisk utstyr (EE-utstyr). Feil håndtering av  
denne typen avfall kan være miljø- og helseskadelig på grunn av potensielt skadelige stoffer som ofte  
brukes i EE-utstyr. Samtidig bidrar din innsats for korrekt avhending av produktet til effektiv bruk av  
naturressurser. Du kan få mer informasjon om hvor du kan avhende utrangert utstyr til resirkulering ved å  
kontakte lokale myndigheter, et godkjent WEEE-program eller husholdningens renovasjonsselskap. Du  
finner mer informasjon om retur og resirkulering av WEEE-produkter på www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Vain Euroopan unionin sekä ETA:n (Norja, Islanti ja Liechtenstein)  
alueelle.  
Tämä tunnus osoittaa, että sähkö- ja elektroniikkalaiteromua koskeva direktiivi (SER-direktiivi,  
2012/19/EU) sekä kansallinen lainsäädäntö kieltävät tuotteen hävittämisen talousjätteen mukana. Tuote  
on vietävä asianmukaiseen keräyspisteeseen, esimerkiksi kodinkoneliikkeeseen uutta vastaavaa tuotetta  
ostettaessa tai viralliseen sähkö- ja elektroniikkalaiteromun keräyspisteeseen. Sähkö- ja  
elektroniikkalaiteromun virheellinen käsittely voi vahingoittaa ympäristöä ja ihmisten terveyttä, koska  
laitteet saattavat sisältää ympäristölle ja terveydelle haitallisia aineita. Lisäksi tuotteen asianmukainen  
hävittäminen säästää luonnonvaroja. Lisätietoja sähkö- ja elektroniikkalaiteromun keräyspisteistä saat  
kaupunkien ja kuntien tiedotuksesta, jätehuoltoviranomaisilta, sähkö- ja elektroniikkalaiteromun  
137  
kierrätysjärjestelmän ylläpitäjältä ja jätehuoltoyhtiöltä. Lisätietoja sähkö- ja elektroniikkalaiteromun  
keräyksestä ja kierrätyksestä on osoitteessa www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Endast för Europeiska unionen och EES (Norge, Island och  
Liechtenstein)  
Den här symbolen visar att produkten enligt WEEE-direktivet (2012/19/EU) och nationell lagstiftning inte  
får sorteras och slängas som hushållsavfall. Den här produkten ska lämnas in på en därför avsedd  
insamlingsplats, t.ex. på en återvinningsstation auktoriserad att hantera elektrisk och elektronisk  
utrustning (EE-utrustning) eller hos handlare som är auktoriserade att byta in varor då nya, motsvarande  
köps (en mot en). Olämplig hantering av avfall av den här typen kan ha en negativ inverkan på miljön och  
människors hälsa på grund av de potentiellt farliga ämnen som kan återfinnas i elektrisk och elektronisk  
utrustning. Din medverkan till en korrekt avfallshantering av den här produkten bidrar dessutom till en  
effektiv användning av naturresurserna. Kontakta ditt lokala kommunkontor, berörd myndighet, företag för  
avfallshantering eller ta del av en godkänd WEEE-organisation om du vill ha mer information om var du  
kan lämna den kasserade produkten för återvinning. För mer information om inlämning och återvinning av  
WEEE-produkter, se www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Pouze Evropská unie a EHP (Norsko, Island a Lichtenštejnsko)  
Tento symbol znamená, že podle směrnice o OEEZ (2012/19/EU) a podle vnitrostátních právních  
předpisů nemá být tento výrobek likvidován s odpadem z domácností. Tento výrobek má být vrácen do  
sběrného místa, např. v rámci autorizovaného systému odběru jednoho výrobku za jeden nově prodaný  
podobný výrobek nebo v autorizovaném sběrném místě pro recyklaci odpadních elektrických a  
elektronických zařízení (OEEZ). Nevhodné nakládání s tímto druhem odpadu by mohlo mít negativní  
dopad na životní prostředí a lidské zdraví, protože elektrická a elektronická zařízení zpravidla obsahují  
potenciálně nebezpečné látky. Vaše spolupráce na správné likvidaci tohoto výrobku současně napomůže  
efektivnímu využívání přírodních zdrojů. Další informace o místech sběru vašeho odpadního zařízení  
k recyklaci vám sdělí místní úřad vaší obce, správní orgán vykonávající dozor nad likvidací odpadu,  
sběrny OEEZ nebo služba pro odvoz komunálního odpadu. Další informace týkající se vracení a  
recyklace OEEZ naleznete na adrese www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Csak az Európai Unió és az EGT (Norvégia, Izland és Liechtenstein)  
országaiban  
138  
Ez a szimbólum azt jelzi, hogy a helyi törvények és a WEEE-irányelv (2012/19/EU) szerint a termék nem  
kezelhető háztartási hulladékként. A terméket a kijelölt nyilvános gyűjtőpontokon kell leadni, például  
hasonló cserekészülék vásárlásakor, illetve bármelyik, elektromos és elektronikai berendezésekből  
származó hulladék (WEEE) átvételére feljogosított gyűjtőponton. Az ilyen jellegű hulladékok a nem  
megfelelő kezelés esetén a bennük található veszélyes anyagok révén ártalmasak lehetnek a környezetre  
és az emberek egészségére. Továbbá, a termékből származó hulladék megfelelő kezelésével  
hozzájárulhat a természetes nyersanyagok hatékonyabb hasznosításához. A berendezésekből származó,  
újrahasznosítható hulladékok elhelyezésére vonatkozó további tudnivalókért forduljon a helyi  
önkormányzathoz, a közterület-fenntartó vállalathoz, a háztartási hulladék begyűjtését végző vállalathoz,  
illetve a hivatalos WEEE-képviselethez. További tudnivalókat a WEEE-termékek visszajuttatásáról és  
újrahasznosításáról a www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Tylko dla krajów Unii Europejskiej oraz EOG (Norwegia, Islandia i  
Liechtenstein)  
Ten symbol oznacza, że zgodnie z dyrektywą WEEE dotyczącą zużytego sprzętu elektrycznego i  
elektronicznego (2012/19/UE) oraz przepisami lokalnymi nie należy wyrzucać tego produktu razem z  
odpadami gospodarstwa domowego. Produkt należy przekazać do wyznaczonego punktu gromadzenia  
odpadów, np. firmie, od której kupowany jest nowy, podobny produkt lub do autoryzowanego punktu  
gromadzenia zużytego sprzętu elektrycznego i elektronicznego w celu poddania go recyklingowi.  
Usuwanie tego typu odpadów w nieodpowiedni sposób może mieć negatywny wpływ na otoczenie i  
zdrowie innych osób ze względu na niebezpieczne substancje stosowane w takim sprzęcie. Jednocześnie  
pozbycie się zużytego sprzętu w zalecany sposób przyczynia się do właściwego wykorzystania zasobów  
naturalnych. Aby uzyskać więcej informacji na temat punktów, do których można dostarczyć sprzęt do  
recyklingu, prosimy skontaktować się z lokalnym urzędem miasta, zakładem utylizacji odpadów,  
skorzystać z instrukcji zatwierdzonej dyrektywą WEEE lub skontaktować się z przedsiębiorstwem  
zajmującym się wywozem odpadów domowych. Więcej informacji o zwracaniu i recyklingu zużytego  
sprzętu elektrycznego i elektronicznego znajduje się w witrynie www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Platí len pre štáty Európskej únie a EHP (Nórsko, Island a  
Lichtenštajnsko)  
Tento symbol znamená, že podľa Smernice 2012/19/EÚ o odpade z elektrických a elektronických  
zariadení (OEEZ) a podľa platnej legislatívy Slovenskej republiky sa tento produkt nesmie likvidovať spolu  
s komunálnym odpadom. Produkt je potrebné odovzdať do určenej zberne, napr. prostredníctvom výmeny  
za kúpu nového podobného produktu, alebo na autorizované zberné miesto, ktoré spracúva odpad z  
elektrických a elektronických zariadení (EEZ). Nesprávna manipulácia s takýmto typom odpadu môže mať  
negatívny vplyv na životné prostredie a ľudské zdravie, pretože elektrické a elektronické zariadenia  
obsahujú potenciálne nebezpečné látky. Spoluprácou na správnej likvidácii produktu prispejete  
139  
k účinnému využívaniu prírodných zdrojov. Ďalšie informácie o mieste recyklácie opotrebovaných  
zariadení získate od miestneho úradu, úradu životného prostredia, zo schváleného plánu OEEZ alebo od  
spoločnosti, ktorá zaisťuje likvidáciu komunálneho odpadu. Viac informácií nájdete aj na webovej stránke:  
www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Üksnes Euroopa Liit ja EMP (Norra, Island ja Liechtenstein)  
See sümbol näitab, et antud toodet ei tohi vastavalt elektri- ja elektroonikaseadmete jäätmeid käsitlevale  
direktiivile (2012/19/EL) ning teie riigis kehtivatele õigusaktidele utiliseerida koos olmejäätmetega. Antud  
toode tuleb anda selleks määratud kogumispunkti, nt müügipunkt, mis on volitatud üks ühe vastu  
vahetama, kui ostate uue sarnase toote, või elektri- ja elektroonikaseadmete jäätmete ümbertöötlemiseks  
mõeldud kogumispunkti. Täiendava teabe saamiseks elektri- ja elektroonikaseadmetest tekkinud jäätmete  
tagastamise ja ümbertöötlemise kohta võtke ühendust kohaliku omavalitsusega, asjakohase  
valitsusasutusega, asjakohase tootjavastutusorganisatsiooniga või olmejäätmete käitlejaga. Lisateavet  
leitate ka Interneti-leheküljelt www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Tikai Eiropas Savienībai un EEZ (Norvēģijai, Islandei un Lihtenšteinai)  
Šis simbols norāda, ka atbilstoši ES Direktīvai (2012/19/ES) par elektrisko un elektronisko iekārtu  
atkritumiem (EEIA) un vietējiem tiesību aktiem no šī izstrādājuma nedrīkst atbrīvoties, izmetot to kopā ar  
sadzīves atkritumiem. Šis izstrādājums ir jānodod piemērotā savākšanas vietā, piemēram, apstiprinātā  
veikalā, kur iegādājaties līdzīgu jaunu produktu un atstājat veco, vai apstiprinātā vietā izlietotu elektrisko  
un elektronisko iekārtu pārstrādei. Nepareiza šāda veida atkritumu apsaimniekošana var apdraudēt vidi  
un cilvēka veselību tādu iespējami bīstamu vielu dēļ, kas parasti ir elektriskajās un elektroniskajās  
iekārtās. Turklāt jūsu atbalsts pareizā šāda veida atkritumu apsaimniekošanā sekmēs efektīvu dabas  
resursu izmantošanu. Lai saņemtu pilnīgāku informāciju par vietām, kur izlietoto iekārtu var nodot  
pārstrādei, sazinieties ar vietējo pašvaldību, atkritumu savākšanas atbildīgo dienestu, pilnvarotu EEIA  
struktūru vai sadzīves atkritumu apsaimniekošanas iestādi. Lai saņemtu plašāku informāciju par elektrisko  
un elektronisko iekārtu nodošanu pārstrādei, apmeklējiet tīmekļa vietni www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Tik Europos Sąjungai ir EEE (Norvegijai, Islandijai ir Lichtenšteinui)  
Šis ženklas reiškia, kad gaminio negalima išmesti su buitinėmis atliekomis, kaip yra nustatyta Direktyvoje  
(2012/19/ES) ir nacionaliniuose teisė aktuose dėl EEĮ atliekų tvarkymo. Šį gaminį reikia atiduoti į tam  
skirtą surinkimo punktą, pvz., pagal patvirtintą keitimo sistemą, kai perkamas panašus gaminys, arba į  
140  
elektros ir elektroninės įrangos (EEĮ) atliekų perdirbimo punktą. Netinkamas tokios rūšies atliekų  
tvarkymas dėl elektros ir elektroninėje įrangoje esančių pavojingų medžiagų gali pakenkti aplinkai ir  
žmonių sveikatai. Padėdami užtikrinti tinkamą šio gaminio šalinimo tvarką, kartu prisidėsite prie  
veiksmingo gamtos išteklių naudojimo. Jei reikia daugiau informacijos, kaip šalinti tokias atliekas, kad jos  
būtų toliau perdirbamos, kreipkitės į savo miesto valdžios institucijas, atliekų tvarkymo organizacijas,  
patvirtintų EEĮ atliekų sistemų arba jūsų buitinių atliekų tvarkymo įstaigų atstovus. Išsamesnės  
informacijos apie EEĮ atliekų grąžinimo ir perdirbimo tvarką galite rasti apsilankę tinklalapyje www.canon-  
europe.com/weee.  
Samo za Evropsko unijo in EGP (Norveška, Islandija in Lihtenštajn)  
Ta simbol pomeni, da tega izdelka v skladu z direktivo OEEO (2012/19/EU) in državno zakonodajo ne  
smete odvreči v gospodinjske odpadke. Ta izdelek morate odložiti na ustrezno zbiralno mesto, na primer  
pri pooblaščenem prodajalcu, ko kupite podoben nov izdelek ali na zbiralno mesto za recikliranje  
električne in elektronske opreme. Neprimerno ravnanje s takšnimi odpadki lahko negativno vpliva na  
okolje in človekovo zdravje zaradi nevarnih snovi, ki so povezane z električno in elektronsko opremo. S  
pravilno odstranitvijo izdelka hkrati prispevate tudi k učinkoviti porabi naravnih virov. Če želite več  
informacij o tem, kje lahko odložite odpadno opremo za recikliranje, pokličite občinski urad, komunalno  
podjetje ali službo, ki skrbi za odstranjevanje odpadkov, ali si oglejte načrt OEEO. Če želite več informacij  
o vračanju in recikliranju izdelkov v skladu z direktivo OEEO, obiščite www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Само за Европейския съюз и ЕИП (Норвегия, Исландия и  
Лихтенщайн)  
Този символ показва, че този продукт не трябва да се изхвърля заедно с битовите отпадъци,  
съгласно Директивата за ИУЕЕО (2012/19/ЕC) и Вашето национално законодателство. Този  
продукт трябва да бъде предаден в предназначен за целта пункт за събиране, например на база  
размяна, когато купувате нов подобен продукт, или в одобрен събирателен пункт за рециклиране  
на излязло от употреба електрическо и електронно оборудване (ИУЕЕО). Неправилното третиране  
на този тип отпадъци може да доведе до евентуални отрицателни последствия за околната среда  
и човешкото здраве поради потенциално опасните вещества, които обикновено са свързани с ЕЕО.  
В същото време Вашето съдействие за правилното изхвърляне на този продукт ще допринесе за  
ефективното използване на природните ресурси. Повече информация относно местата, където  
може да предавате излязло от употреба оборудване за рециклиране, може да получите от  
местните власти, от органа, отговорен за отпадъците и от одобрена система за излязло от  
употреба ЕЕО или от Вашата местна служба за битови отпадъци. За повече информация относно  
връщането и рециклирането на продукти от излязло от употреба ЕЕО посетете www.canon-  
europe.com/weee.  
141  
Doar pentru Uniunea Europeană şi EEA (Norvegia, Islanda şi  
Liechtenstein)  
Acest simbol indică faptul că acest produs nu trebuie aruncat o dată cu reziduurile menajere, în  
conformitate cu Directiva DEEE (Directiva privind deşeurile de echipamente electrice şi electronice)  
(2012/19/UE) şi legile naţionale. Acest produs trebuie transportat la un punct de colectare special, de  
exemplu un centru care preia produsele vechi atunci când achiziţionaţi un produs nou similar, sau la un  
punct de colectare autorizat pentru reciclarea deşeurilor provenite de la echipamentele electrice şi  
electronice (EEE). Mânuirea necorespunzătoare a acestor tipuri de deşeuri poate avea un impact negativ  
asupra mediului înconjurător şi sănătăţii indivizilor, din cauza substanţelor potenţial nocive care sunt în  
general asociate cu EEE. În acelaşi timp, cooperarea dvs. la reciclarea corectă a acestui produs va  
contribui la utilizarea efectivă a resurselor naturale. Pentru mai multe informaţii privind locurile de reciclare  
a deşeurilor provenite de la echipamente, contactaţi biroul primăriei locale, autoritatea responsabilă cu  
colectarea deşeurilor, schema DEEE aprobată sau serviciul de colectare a deşeurilor menajere. Pentru  
mai multe informaţii privind returnarea şi reciclarea produselor DEEE, vizitaţi www.canon-europe.com/  
weee.  
Samo za Europsku uniju i EEZ (Norveška, Island i Lihtenštajn)  
Ovaj simbol pokazuje da se ovaj proizvod ne smije odlagati s kućnim otpadom sukladno WEEE Direktivi  
(2012/19/EC) i vašem nacionalnom zakonu. Ovaj proizvod je potrebno predati na posebno mjesto za  
sakupljanje otpada, npr. na ovlašteno mjesto gdje možete zamijeniti staro za novo ukoliko kupujete novi  
sličan proizvod ili na ovlašteno mjesto za sakupljanje rabljene električne i elektroničke opreme (EEE) za  
recikliranje. Nepropisno rukovanje ovom vrstom otpada može imati negativan učinak na okolinu i zdravlje  
ljudi zbog supstanci koje su potencijalno opasne za zdravlje, a općenito se povezuju s EEE. Istovremeno,  
vaša će suradnja kroz propisno odlaganje ovog proizvoda doprinijeti efektivnoj uporabi prirodnih resursa.  
Za više informacija o tome gdje možete odložiti svoj otpad za recikliranje obratite se vašem lokalnom  
gradskom uredu, komunalnoj službi, odobrenom WEEE programu ili službi za odlaganje kućnog otpada.  
Ostale informacije o vraćanju i recikliranju WEEE proizvoda potražite na www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
Korisnici u Srbiji  
Ovaj simbol označava da ovaj proizvod ne sme da se odlaže sa ostalim kućnim otpadom, u skladu sa  
WEEE Direktivom (2012/19/EU) i nacionalnim zakonima. Ovaj proizvod treba predati određenom centru  
za prikupljanje, npr. na osnovi "jedan-za-jedan" kada kupujete sličan novi proizvod, ili ovlašćenom centru  
za prikupljanje za reciklažu istrošene električne i elektronske opreme (EEE). Nepravilno rukovanje ovom  
142  
vrstom otpada može da ima moguće negativne posledice po životnu sredinu i ljudsko zdravlje usled  
potencijalno opasnih materijala koji se uglavnom vezuju za EEE. U isto vreme, vaša saradnja na  
ispravnom odlaganju ovog proizvoda će doprineti efikasnom korišćenju prirodnih resursa. Za više  
informacija o tome gde možete da predate vašu staru opremu radi recikliranje, vas molimo, da  
kontaktirate lokalne gradske vlasti, komunalne službe, odobreni plan reciklaže ili Gradsku čistoću. Za više  
informacija o vraćanju i recikliranju WEEE proizvoda, posetite stranicu www.canon-europe.com/weee.  
143  
Legal Restrictions on Scanning/Copying  
Scanning, printing, copying, or modifying copies of the following may be punishable under law.  
This list is non-exhaustive. When in doubt, check with a local legal representative.  
• Paper money  
• Money orders  
• Certificates of deposit  
• Postage stamps (canceled or uncanceled)  
• Identification badges or insignia  
• Selective service or draft papers  
• Checks or drafts issued by governmental agencies  
• Motor vehicle licenses and certificates of title  
• Traveler's checks  
• Food stamps  
• Passports  
• Immigration papers  
• Internal revenue stamps (canceled or uncanceled)  
• Bonds or other certificates of indebtedness  
• Stock certificates  
• Copyrighted works or works of art, without the owner's consent  
145  
 
Transporting Your Printer  
When relocating the printer for changing your living place or repairing it, make sure of the following.  
Important  
• Pack the printer in a sturdy box so that it is placed with its bottom facing down, using sufficient  
protective material to ensure safe transport.  
• With the FINE cartridge left installed in the printer, press the ON button to turn off the power. This  
allows the printer to automatically cap the print head, thus preventing it from drying.  
• After packing, do not tilt the box containing the printer or turn it on its side or upside down. Doing so  
may cause the ink to leak during transport and cause damage to the printer.  
• When a shipping agent is handling transport of the printer, have its box marked "THIS SIDE UP" to  
keep the printer with its bottom facing down. Mark also with "FRAGILE" or "HANDLE WITH CARE".  
1. Turn the printer off.  
2. Check that ON lamp is off and unplug power cord.  
Important  
• Do not unplug the printer while the ON lamp is lit or flashing, as it may cause malfunction or  
damage to the printer, making the printer unable to print.  
3. Retract the paper output support with the output tray extension closed.  
4. Close the front cover.  
5. Unplug the printer cable from the computer and from the printer, then unplug the power  
cord from the printer.  
6. Use adhesive tape to secure all the covers on the printer to keep them from opening during  
transportation. Then pack the printer in the plastic bag.  
7. Attach the protective material to the printer when packing the printer in the box.  
146  
 
Important  
• We recommend to hold and carry out this printer as shown in the figure below. If you hold the front  
cover or the cassette, it may fall out of the printer.  
147  
When Repairing, Lending, or Disposing of the Printer  
If you have entered personal data, passwords and/or other security settings on the printer, such information  
may be stored in the printer.  
When sending the printer for repair, lending or transferring the printer to another person, or disposing of the  
printer, please be sure to follow the steps below in order to delete such information and prevent third parties  
from accessing it.  
Press the Setup button and select Device settings > Reset setting > All data. Next, press the OK button  
and select Yes.  
For printers with fax capabilities, user information and speed dial numbers can be backed up to a computer  
by utilizing the Speed Dial Utility2 software before resetting the printer or deleting data. Backed up data can  
be restored to the repaired printer or another Canon printer.  
Registering Recipients Using Speed Dial Utility2 (Windows)  
148  
 
Keeping Print Quality High  
The key to printing with the optimal printing quality is to prevent the print head from drying or clogging.  
Always observe the following rules for optimal printing quality.  
Note  
• Depending on the type of paper, ink may blur if you trace the printed area with a highlight pen or paint-  
stick, or bleed if water or sweat comes in contact with the printed area.  
Never unplug the power cord until the power is turned off!  
If you press the ON button to turn off the power, the printer caps the print head (nozzles) automatically to  
prevent from drying. If you unplug the power cord from the wall outlet before the ON lamp is turned off, the  
print head will not be capped properly and this will cause drying or clogging.  
When unplugging the power cord, check that the ON lamp is not lit.  
Important  
• If the power cord is unplugged, the date/time settings will be reset and all documents stored in the  
printer's memory will be lost. Send or print a necessary document before unplugging the power cord.  
Print periodically!  
Just as the tip of a felt pen becomes dry and unusable if it has not been used for a long time, even if it is  
capped, the print head too, may become dried or clogged if the printer has not been used for a long time.  
We recommend you to use the printer at least once a month.  
149  
 
Front View  
A: Operation Panel  
Use to change the settings of the printer or to operate it.  
B: Platen  
Load an original here.  
C: Document Cover  
Open to load an original on the platen.  
D: Paper Guides  
Align with both sides of the paper stack.  
E: Cassette  
Load paper here. Two or more sheets of the same size and type of paper can be loaded at the same  
time, and fed automatically one sheet at a time.  
F: Paper Output Tray  
Printed paper is ejected.  
G: Paper Output Support  
Extend to support ejected paper.  
H: Output Tray Extension  
Open to support ejected paper.  
152  
 
I: Paper Output Cover  
Open to replace the FINE cartridge or remove jammed paper inside the printer.  
J: ON button  
Turns the power on or off. Before turning on the power, make sure that the document cover is closed.  
K: ON lamp  
Lights after flashing when the power is turned on.  
L: FAX Memory lamp  
Lights when there are received or unsent documents stored in the printer's memory.  
M: Alarm lamp  
Lights or flashes when an error occurs.  
N: ADF (Auto Document Feeder)  
Load a document here. The documents loaded in the document tray are scanned automatically one  
sheet at a time.  
O: Document Feeder Cover  
Open when clearing jammed documents.  
P: Document Guide  
Adjust this guide to match the width of document in the ADF.  
Q: Document Tray  
Open to load a document in the ADF. You can load two or more sheets of document of the same size  
and thickness. Load the document with the side you want to scan facing up.  
R: Document Output Slot  
Documents scanned from the ADF are delivered here.  
S: Front Cover  
Open to load paper in the cassette.  
153  
Rear View  
A: Power Cord Connector  
Plug in the supplied power cord.  
B: Rear Cover  
Open when removing jammed paper.  
C: Telephone Line Jack  
Connect the telephone line.  
D: External Device Jack  
Connect an external device such as telephone or answering device.  
E: USB Port  
Plug in the USB cable to connect the printer with a computer.  
F: Transport Unit Cover  
Detach when removing jammed paper.  
Important  
• Do not touch the metal casing.  
• Do not plug in or unplug the USB cable while the printer is printing or scanning with the computer. This  
can cause trouble.  
154  
 
Inside View  
A: FINE Cartridge (ink cartridges)  
A replaceable cartridge that integrates print head and ink tank.  
B: FINE Cartridge Holder  
Install the FINE cartridge.  
The color FINE cartridge should be installed into the left slot and the black FINE cartridge should be  
installed into the right slot.  
Note  
• For details on replacing a FINE cartridge, see Replacing a FINE Cartridge.  
Important  
• The area around the parts C may be splattered with ink. This does not affect the performance of the  
printer.  
• Do not touch the parts C. The printer may not print properly if you touch them.  
155  
 
Operation Panel  
A: LCD (Liquid Crystal Display)  
Displays messages, menu items, and the operational status.  
B: Back button  
Returns the LCD to the previous screen.  
C: FAX button  
Switches the printer to the fax mode.  
D: COPY button  
Switches the printer to the copy mode.  
E: SCAN button  
Switches the printer to the scan mode.  
F: Setup button  
Displays the Setup menu screen. With this menu, you can perform printer maintenance and change  
printer settings.  
G: Black button  
Starts black & white copying, scanning, faxing, etc.  
H: Color button  
Starts color copying, scanning, faxing, etc.  
I:  
and  
buttons  
Used to select a menu or setting item. The  
button is also used when entering characters.  
156  
 
J: OK button  
Finalizes the selection of a menu or setting item. This button is also used to resolve an error or ejects  
documents in the ADF (Auto Document Feeder).  
K: Menu/Wireless connect button  
Displays the Copy menu, Scan menu, or FAX menu screen.  
To set wireless router information in the printer directly from a smartphone or other such device (without  
having to do any procedures at the router), hold down this button.  
L: Numeric buttons  
Used to enter numerical values such as the number of copies, as well as fax/telephone numbers and  
characters.  
M: Tone button  
Switches to tone dialing temporarily if your printer is connected to a rotary pulse line.  
N: Stop button  
Cancels operation when print, copy, scan, or fax transmission/reception job is in progress.  
Note  
• The printer makes the beep sound when pressing keypad buttons on the operation panel. The keypad  
sound can be enabled or disabled in Sound control of Other dev. settings.  
157  
Checking that Power Is On  
The ON lamp is lit when the printer is turned on.  
Even if the LCD is off, if the ON lamp is lit, the printer is on.  
Note  
• It may take a while for the printer to start printing immediately after you turn on the printer.  
• The LCD will turn off if the printer is not operated for about 10 minutes. To restore the display, press  
any button or perform the print operation. The display will be also restored when receiving faxes. You  
cannot change the wait time before the LCD turns off.  
159  
 
Turning the Printer On and Off  
Turning on the printer  
1. Press the ON button to turn on the printer.  
The ON lamp flashes and then remains lit.  
Note  
• It may take a while for the printer to start printing immediately after you turn on the printer.  
• If an error message is displayed on the LCD, see An Error Occurs.  
• You can set the printer to automatically turn on when a print or scan operation is performed  
from a computer connected by USB cable or wireless network. This feature is set to off by  
default.  
From the printer  
From the computer  
• For Windows:  
Managing the Printer Power  
• For macOS:  
Turning off the printer  
1. Press the ON button to turn off the printer.  
When the ON lamp stops flashing, the printer is turned off.  
160  
 
Important  
• When you unplug the power cord after turning off the printer, be sure to confirm that the ON  
lamp is off.  
Note  
• You can set the printer to automatically turn off when no operations are performed or no print  
jobs are sent to the printer for a certain interval. This feature is set to on by default.  
From the printer  
From the computer  
• For Windows:  
Managing the Printer Power  
• For macOS:  
161  
Checking the Power Plug/Power Cord  
Check the power plug/power cord once a month to confirm that it does not have anything unusual described  
below.  
• The power plug/power cord is hot.  
• The power plug/power cord is rusty.  
• The power plug/power cord is bent.  
• The power plug/power cord is worn.  
• The power plug/power cord is split.  
Caution  
• If you find anything unusual with the power plug/power cord described above, unplug the power cord  
and call for service. Using the printer with one of the unusual conditions above may cause a fire or an  
electric shock.  
162  
 
Unplugging the Printer  
To unplug the power cord, follow the procedure below.  
Important  
• When you unplug the power cord, press the ON button, then confirm that the ON lamp is off.  
Unplugging the power cord while the ON lamp is lit or flashing may cause drying or clogging of the print  
head and print quality may be reduced.  
• If the power cord is unplugged, the date/time settings will be reset and all documents stored in the  
printer's memory will be lost. Send or print a necessary document before unplugging the power cord.  
1. Press the ON button to turn the printer off.  
2. Confirm that the ON lamp is off.  
3. Unplug the power cord.  
The specification of the power cord differs depending on the country or region of use.  
163  
 
LCD and Operation Panel  
The mode button (A) on the operation panel allows you to switch between the copy mode, scan mode, fax  
mode, and setup menu screen.  
Pressing the Menu/Wireless connect button (B) in the respective modes shows the menu screen to select  
various functions or settings.  
Selecting a Menu or Setting Item  
On the menu screen or settings screen, use the  
button (C) to select an item or option, then press  
the OK button (D) to proceed with the procedure.  
To return to the previous screen, press the Back button (E).  
Example: Changing the scan contrast for faxing.  
1. Press Menu/Wireless connect button in Fax standby screen.  
2. Press the  
button (C) to select FAX TX settings.  
3. Press the OK button (D).  
164  
   
4. Select Scan contrast, press the OK button (D).  
5. Use the  
button (C) to change the contrast, then press the OK button (D).  
Network Status Indication  
Wi-Fi setting and the network status indicate by the icon.  
If the  
icon appears on the LCD when the SCAN button or Setup button is pressed, it indicates  
that Wi-Fi is enabled and the printer is connected to the wireless router.  
Depending on the signal state, the icon will change.  
Signal strength: 81 % or more  
You can use the printer over Wi-Fi without any problems.  
Signal strength: 51 % or more  
The problem such as the printer cannot print may occur according to the network sta-  
tus. We recommend placing the printer near the wireless router.  
Signal strength: 50 % or less  
The problem such as the printer cannot print may occur. Place the printer near the  
wireless router.  
Wi-Fi is enabled but the printer is not connected to the wireless router.  
Note  
• When Wi-Fi is disabled,  
icon is not displayed.  
165  
Entering Numbers, Letters, and Symbols  
Use the Numeric buttons to enter or edit such information as unit name, a recipient's name for the directory,  
etc.  
Switching the Input Mode  
Each time the Tone button is pressed, the input mode is switched.  
The current input mode appears at the upper right corner of the LCD.  
Note  
• Only numbers and symbols that are available for the type of information you are entering are  
displayed, such as numbers for telephone or fax number input.  
Entering Numbers, Letters, and Symbols  
Press the Tone button to switch the input mode.  
Use the Numeric buttons to enter the desired characters.  
• To insert a space  
Press the  
button five times.  
• To delete the last entered character  
Press the Back button.  
Editing Entered Numbers, Letters, and Symbols  
Press the  
or  
button to move the cursor under the position you want to edit.  
• To insert a space  
Press the  
button five times.  
• To insert a character  
Move the cursor under the character to the right of the insertion position, then enter the character. The  
character on the cursor will move to the right and the new character will be inserted.  
• To delete a character  
Move the cursor under the character, then press the Back button.  
166  
 
List of Characters Assigned to Each Numeric Button  
For Fax/Telephone Number, Name, Number of Copies  
Lowercase mode  
(:a)  
Uppercase mode  
(:A)  
Numeric mode  
(:1)  
Fax/Tele-  
Button  
phone no.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
#
abcåäáàãâæç  
ABCÅÄÁÀÃÂÆÇ  
defëéèê  
gh i ï í ì î  
jkl  
DEFËÉÈÊ  
GH I Ï Í Ì Î  
JKL  
mnoñøöóòõô  
pqrsþ  
MNOÑØÖÓÒÕÔ  
PQRSÞ  
tuvüúùû  
wxyzý  
TUVÜÚÙÛ  
WXYZÝ  
. @ - _ SP*1 # ! " , ; : ^ ` = / | ' ? $ % & + ( ) [ ] { } < >  
Switch the input mode.  
*1 "SP" indicates a space.  
For LAN Settings  
Lowercase mode  
(:a)  
Uppercase mode  
(:A)  
Numeric mode  
(:1)  
Button  
1
2
3
4
5
6
abc  
def  
gh i  
jkl  
ABC  
DEF  
GH I  
JKL  
mno  
MNO  
167  
 
pqrs  
tuv  
PQRS  
TUV  
7
8
9
0
wxyz  
WXYZ  
~
. @ - _ SP*2 # ! " , ; : ^ ` = / | ' ? $ % & + ( ) [ ] { } < > \  
Switch the input mode.  
*2 "SP" indicates a space.  
168  
 
Changing Settings  
Changing Printer Settings from Your Computer (Windows)  
169  
 
Changing Printer Settings from Your Computer (macOS)  
170  
 
Managing the Printer Power  
Printer power supply is operated from Remote UI.  
Energy saving settings  
Energy saving settings allow you to set Auto power off and Auto power on.  
Auto power off is the function wherein the printer automatically turns itself off, when data is not sent or  
the printer remains inactive for a certain period.  
The Auto power on function automatically turns on the printer when data is received.  
1. Selecting Device settings from Remote UI  
2. Click Energy saving settings  
3. Complete the following settings:  
Auto power off  
Specify the time from the list. Printer automatically turns itself off, when data is not sent within the  
specified time or the printer has remained inactive.  
Auto power on  
When you check this check box, the printer automatically turns itself on when data is sent.  
4. Apply the settings  
Click OK.  
The printer will operate with the changed settings hereafter.  
171  
 
Changing the Printer Operation Mode  
If necessary, switch between various modes of printer operation.  
1. Check whether the printer is on and select Device settings from Remote UI  
2. If necessary, complete the following settings:  
Print settings - Prevent paper abrasion  
The printer can increase the gap between the print head and the paper during high-density printing  
to prevent paper abrasion.  
Check this check box to prevent paper abrasion.  
Custom settings - Detect paper setting mismatch  
If the check box is deselected, at the time of printing from PC, you can continue to print without the  
message display even if the paper settings set in the Print dialog differs from the paper information  
registered to the printer.  
Ink drying wait time  
You can set the length of the printer rest time until printing of the next page begins. The wait time  
becomes longer as the value set in the list increases, and shorter as the value decreases.  
If the paper gets stained because the next page is ejected before the ink on the printed page dries,  
increase the ink drying wait time.  
Reducing the ink drying wait time speeds up printing.  
3. Apply the settings  
Click OK.  
The printer operates with the modified settings hereafter.  
172  
 
Changing Settings from Operation Panel  
This section describes the procedure to change the settings in the Device settings screen, taking the steps  
to specify Extended copy amt. as an example.  
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
2. Press the Setup button.  
The Setup menu screen is displayed.  
3. Select Device settings and then press the OK button.  
The Device settings screen is displayed.  
4. Select a setting item to adjust and then press the OK button.  
The setting screen for the selected item is displayed.  
5. Select a setting item and then press the OK button.  
6. Select a setting to specify and then press the OK button.  
For more on setting items on the operation panel:  
174  
 
FAX settings  
Select this menu from Setup menu.  
Note  
• Before changing the settings, you can confirm the current settings by printing USER'S DATA LIST.  
Summary of Reports and Lists  
Easy setup  
The printer must be set up depending on your telephone line and use of the faxing function. Follow the  
procedure according to the instructions on the LCD.  
Note  
• You can specify the setup setting individually or the advanced setting.  
For details on how to specify the setting:  
TEL no. registration  
You can register the recipient's fax/telephone number to the printer.  
FAX user settings  
Unit TEL no. registr.  
Registers your fax/telephone number printed on sent faxes.  
Unit name registr.  
Registers your name printed on sent faxes.  
Telephone line type (Country or region of purchase other than China)  
Selects the telephone line type setting for the printer.  
176  
       
Note  
• This setting may not be available depending on the country or region of purchase.  
TEL line auto select (China only)  
If you select ON, the telephone line type is selected automatically.  
If you select OFF, you can select the telephone line type manually.  
Adv. FAX settings  
Err reduction (VoIP)  
If you select Reduce, it may be possible to reduce the incidence of communication errors when  
connecting to internet line such as IP phone.  
Note  
• When Reduce is selected, V.34 (Super G3) cannot be used. Communication time generally  
becomes longer than when communicating with V.34 (super G3).  
• This setting has priority even if you select 33600 bps for TX start speed or RX start speed.  
Auto redial  
Enables/disables automatic redialing.  
If you select ON, you can specify the maximum number of redial attempts and the length of time the  
printer waits between redial attempts.  
Dial tone detect  
Avoids mistransmission when reception and transmission occur at the same time.  
If you select ON, the printer transmits the fax after confirming the dial tone.  
Note  
• This setting may not be available depending on the country or region of purchase.  
Pause time settings  
Sets the length of pause time for each when you enter "P" (pause).  
TTI position  
Selects the position of the sender information (outside or inside the image area).  
Remote RX  
Enables/disables remote reception.  
If you select ON, you can specify the remote reception ID.  
Remote Reception  
177  
 
Color transmission  
When faxing color documents using the ADF (Auto Document Feeder), selects whether to convert  
them into black & white data if the recipient's fax device does not support color faxing.  
If you select If incompatible, end, the printer does not send color documents when the recipient's fax  
device does not support color faxing.  
If you select If incompat., B&W, the printer send documents in black & white when the recipient's fax  
device does not support color faxing.  
RX image reduction  
Enables/disables automatic reduction of incoming faxes so that they fit in the selected paper.  
If you select ON, you can select the image reduction direction.  
Adv. communication  
ECM TX  
Selects whether to send faxes in Error Correction Mode (ECM).  
Transmission/Reception of Faxes Using ECM  
ECM RX  
Selects whether to receive faxes in Error Correction Mode (ECM).  
Transmission/Reception of Faxes Using ECM  
TX start speed  
Selects the fax transmission speed.  
Ex:  
The following settings are available.  
33600 bps/14400 bps/9600 bps/4800 bps  
The fax transmission start speed will be faster as the value is bigger.  
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
• Some of settings are not available depending on the country or region of purchase.  
• When the telephone line condition or connection is poor, selecting a lower transmission start  
speed may solve transmission problems.  
RX start speed  
Selects the fax reception speed.  
Ex:  
The following settings are available.  
178  
33600 bps/14400 bps/9600 bps/4800 bps  
The fax reception start speed will be faster as the value is bigger.  
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
• Some of settings are not available depending on the country or region of purchase.  
• When the telephone line condition or connection is poor, selecting a lower reception start  
speed may solve reception problems.  
Auto print settings  
Received documents  
Selects whether to print the received fax automatically when receiving a fax.  
If you select Do not print, the received fax is stored in the printer's memory.  
For details on the received fax stored in the printer's memory:  
Activity report  
Selects whether to print ACTIVITY REPORT automatically.  
If you select Print, the printer prints ACTIVITY REPORT for the 20 histories of sent and received  
faxes automatically.  
For details on the procedure to print ACTIVITY REPORT manually:  
Summary of Reports and Lists  
TX report  
Selects whether to print TX REPORT/ERROR TX REPORT automatically after sending a fax.  
If you print the report, select Print error only or Print for each TX.  
If you select Print error only or Print for each TX, you can specify the print setting that the first page  
of the fax is printed along with the report.  
RX report  
Selects whether to print RX REPORT automatically after receiving a fax.  
If you print RX REPORT, select Print error only or Print for each RX.  
Print when no ink  
Sets whether to continue printing the received fax without storing it in the printer's memory when the  
ink has run out.  
However, part or all of the fax may not be printed since the ink has run out.  
179  
 
Security control  
FAX no. re-entry  
If you select ON, you can set the printer to send faxes after using the Numeric buttons to enter the  
number twice. By using this setting, you can avoid the mistransmission of faxes.  
Preventing Mistransmission of Faxes  
Check RX FAX info  
If you select ON, the printer checks whether the recipient's fax device information matches the dialed  
number. If it matches the number, the printer starts to send faxes.  
Preventing Mistransmission of Faxes  
Hook setting  
If you select Enable, you can use the on hook dial function.  
FAX RX reject  
If you select ON, the printer rejects the reception of faxes with no sender information or faxes from  
specific senders.  
Rejecting Fax Reception  
Caller rejection  
If you subscribe to the Caller ID service, the printer detects the sender's Caller ID. If the sender's ID  
matches the condition specified in this setting, the printer rejects the phone call or fax reception from  
the sender.  
If you select Subscribed, you can specify the settings of rejection.  
Using Caller ID Service to Reject Calls  
Note  
• This setting may not be supported depending on the country or region of purchase. Contact your  
telephone company to confirm whether it provides this service.  
180  
 
Print settings  
Select this menu from Device settings in Setup menu.  
Prevent abrasion  
Use this setting only if the print surface becomes smudged.  
Important  
• Be sure to set this back to OFF after printing since it may result in lower printing speed or lower  
print quality.  
Extended copy amt.  
Selects the amount of image that extends off the paper when copying in Borderless (full).  
Slight cropping may occur at the edges since the copied image is enlarged to fill the whole page. You  
can change the width to be cropped from the borders of the original image as needed.  
Cropped area will be larger if Amount: Large is selected.  
Note  
• If printouts contain margins even though you are copying in Borderless, specifying Amount: Large  
for this setting may help solve the problem.  
Prevent double-feed  
Select ON to prevent double-feed of plain paper.  
Important  
• Be sure to set this back to OFF after printing since it may result in lower printing speed.  
181  
 
LAN settings  
Select this menu from Device settings in Setup menu.  
Wi-Fi  
Enable/disab. Wi-Fi  
Enables or disables Wi-Fi.  
Wi-Fi setup  
Selects the setup method for Wi-Fi connection.  
Note  
• You can also enter this setting menu by selecting Wi-Fi setup from the Setup menu screen.  
Easy Wi-Fi connect  
Select if you specify the settings of the access point information to the printer directly from a  
device (such as a smartphone) without operating the wireless router. Follow the on-screen  
instructions of the connecting device for the setup procedure.  
Manual connect  
Select when you perform settings for Wi-Fi manually using the operation panel of the printer.  
WPS (Push button)  
Select when you perform settings for Wi-Fi using a wireless router supporting a Wi-Fi Protected  
Setup (WPS) push button method. Follow the on-screen instructions during setup.  
Other setup  
Manual setup  
Select when you perform settings for Wi-Fi manually. You can specify multiple WEP keys.  
WPS (PIN code)  
Select when you perform settings for Wi-Fi using a wireless router supporting a Wi-Fi  
Protected Setup (WPS) PIN code method. Follow the on-screen instructions during setup.  
Manual setup  
For details on each setting item:  
Wireless Direct  
Switch WL Direct  
Enables/disables Wireless Direct.  
182  
     
Change name (SSID)  
Changes the identifier (SSID/the printer's name displayed on a Wi-Fi Direct compatible device) for  
Wireless Direct.  
Change password  
Changes the password for Wireless Direct.  
Confirm request  
Set whether the printer displays the confirmation screen when a Wi-Fi Direct compatible device is  
connecting the printer.  
Manual setup  
For details on each setting item:  
Print LAN details  
You can print out the network settings of the printer such as its IP address and SSID.  
For more information on the printer's network setting is printed out:  
Important  
• The network settings printout contains important information about your network. Handle it with care.  
Manual setup  
Set printer name  
Specifies the printer name. You can use up to 15 characters for the name.  
Note  
• You cannot use the same printer name as that already used for other LAN connected devices.  
• You cannot use a hyphen for the initial or last character of the printer name.  
TCP/IP settings  
Performs IPv4 or IPv6 setting.  
WSD setting  
Setting items when you use WSD (one of the network protocols supported in Windows).  
Enable/disable WSD  
Selects whether WSD is enabled or disabled.  
Note  
• When this setting is enabled, the printer icon is displayed on the Network Explorer in Windows.  
183  
   
Optimize WSD-In  
Selecting Active allows you to receive the WSD printing data faster.  
WSD scan from dev.  
Selecting Active allows you to transfer the scanned data to the computer using WSD.  
Timeout setting  
Specifies the timeout length.  
Bonjour settings  
Setting items for LAN using Bonjour for macOS.  
Enab./disab. Bonjour  
Selecting Active allows you to use Bonjour to perform the network settings.  
Enter service name  
Specifies the Bonjour service name. You can use up to 48 characters for the name.  
Note  
• You cannot use the same service name as that already used for other LAN connected devices.  
LPR setting  
Enables/disables the LPR setting.  
RAW protocol  
Enables/disables RAW printing.  
LLMNR  
Enables/disables LLMNR (Link-Local Multicast Name Resolution). Selecting Active allows the printer  
to detect printer's IP address from the printer name without a DNS server.  
IPP settings  
Selecting Active allows you to print via the network with the IPP protocol.  
IPsec settings  
Selecting Active allows you to specify the IPsec settings.  
184  
Other dev. settings  
Select this menu from Device settings in Setup menu.  
Date/time setting  
Sets the current date and time.  
Important  
• If a power failure occurs or you unplug the power cord, the date/time settings will be reset.  
Date display format  
Sets the format of dates displayed on the LCD and printed on sent faxes.  
DST setting  
Some countries adopt the daylight saving time (summer time) system that shifts the clock time forward  
at certain periods of the year.  
You can set your printer to automatically change the time by registering the date and time that daylight  
saving time (summer time) begins and ends.  
Note  
• This setting may not be available depending on the country or region of purchase.  
Sound control  
Selects whether the beep sound in operations is enabled or not.  
Keypad sound  
Selects whether the beep sound is enabled or not when pressing the buttons on the operation  
panel.  
Alarm sound  
Selects whether the alarm is enabled or not.  
Line monitor sound  
Selects whether the line monitor sound is enabled or not.  
Offhook alarm  
Selects whether the alarm is enabled or not when the phone receiver is not put on the hook  
properly.  
Country or region  
Selects the country or region where you are using the printer.  
Note  
• This setting may not be available depending on the country or region of purchase.  
185  
 
Key repeat  
Enables/Disables continuous input by pressing and holding down the  
number of copies, the zoom ratio, etc.  
button when setting the  
Doc. remov. reminder  
Selects whether the printer will display the reminder screen in case you forget to remove the original  
from the platen after scanning.  
Important  
• Depending on the type of original or the state of the document cover, forgetting to remove the  
original may not be detected.  
186  
Language selection  
Changes the language for LCD messages and menus.  
Japanese / English / German / French / Italian / Spanish / Dutch / Portuguese / Norwegian / Swedish /  
Danish / Finnish / Russian / Ukrainian / Polish / Czech / Slovak / Hungarian / Slovene / Croatian /  
Romanian / Bulgarian / Turkish / Greek / Estonian / Latvian / Lithuanian / Simplified Chinese / Traditional  
Chinese / Korean / Indonesian / Vietnamese  
187  
 
Firmware update  
Select this menu from Device settings in Setup menu.  
You can update the firmware of the printer, check the firmware version, or perform settings of a notification  
screen.  
Important  
• When you use this function, make sure the printer is connected to the internet.  
Note  
• Only Current version is available when Inactive is selected for Enable/disab. Wi-Fi in Wi-Fi under  
LAN settings.  
Install update  
Performs the firmware update of the printer. Follow the on-screen instructions to perform update.  
Note  
• If the firmware update is not complete, check the following and take an appropriate action.  
• Check the network settings such as a wireless router.  
• If Cannot connect to the server; try again is displayed on the LCD, press the OK button and  
try again after a while.  
Current version  
You can check the current firmware version.  
Update notification  
When ON is selected and the firmware update is available, the screen to inform you of the firmware  
update is displayed on the LCD.  
DNS server setup  
Performs settings for a DNS server. Select Auto setup or Manual setup. If you select Manual setup,  
follow the display on the LCD to perform settings.  
Proxy server setup  
Performs settings for a proxy server. Select Use or Do not use. If you select Use, follow the display on  
the LCD to perform settings.  
188  
 
Reset setting  
Select this menu from Device settings in Setup menu.  
Returns all settings you made to the printer back to the default. However, some data may not be changed,  
depending on the current usage state of your printer.  
Important  
• Depending on the setting item, it is necessary to perform connection or setup again after you have  
returned the setting back to the default.  
Web service setup  
Returns the Web service settings back to the default.  
LAN settings  
Returns the LAN settings back to the default.  
Telephone no. data  
Returns the telephone/fax number settings to default.  
Setting data  
Returns the settings such as the paper size, media type, or other setting items other than the LAN  
settings or the fax settings back to the default.  
FAX settings  
Returns the fax settings back to the default. Disconnect the telephone line from the printer before you  
return this setting item back to the default.  
After resetting, perform setup again as necessary.  
All data  
Sets all settings you made to the printer back to the default. The administrator password specified by  
Remote UI or IJ Network Device Setup Utility reverts to the default setting.  
After resetting, perform setup again as necessary.  
Note  
• You cannot set the following setting items back to the default:  
• The language displayed on the LCD  
• The current position of the print head  
• CSR (Certificate Signing Request) for encryption method (SSL/TLS) setting  
• The country or region selected for Country or region  
You can delete the registered user's name or telephone number following the procedure below.  
1. Displays Unit TEL no. registr. or Displays Unit name registr..  
2. Delete all the numbers and the letters by pressing the Back button.  
189  
 
3. Press the OK button after deleting all the numbers and the letters.  
190  
Feed settings  
Select this menu from Setup menu.  
By registering the paper size and the media type loaded in the cassette, you can prevent the printer from  
misprinting by displaying the message before printing starts when the paper size or the media type of the  
loaded paper differs from the print settings.  
For details:  
Save paper info  
Saves the paper size and the media type you load in the cassette.  
Note  
• For more on the proper combination of paper settings you can specify by the printer driver  
(Windows) or on the LCD:  
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Media Type)  
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Paper Size)  
Det. paper mismatch  
If you select ON, the printer detects whether the paper size and the media type are identical with those  
registered in Save paper info. If printing starts with the settings that do not match, an error message is  
displayed on the LCD.  
Note  
• When OFF is selected, Detect reinsertion is disabled.  
Detect reinsertion  
If you select ON, the printer detects the cassette is reinserted. When the Save paper info screen is  
displayed, register the paper size and the media type.  
191  
 
Web service setup  
Select this menu from Setup menu.  
Connection setup  
The following setting items are available.  
GoogleCloudPrint  
Registers/Deletes the printer to/from Google Cloud Print.  
DNS server setup  
Performs settings for a DNS server. Select Auto setup or Manual setup. If you select Manual setup,  
follow the display on the LCD to perform settings.  
Proxy server setup  
Performs settings for a proxy server. Select Use or Do not use. If you select Use, follow the display on  
the LCD to perform settings.  
192  
 
ECO settings  
This setting allows you to turn on/off the printer automatically to save electricity.  
Turning off Printer Automatically  
You can enable the printer to turn off automatically when no operation is made or no printing data is sent  
to the printer for a specified period of time.  
2. Press the Setup button.  
The Setup menu screen is displayed.  
3. Select ECO settings and then press the OK button.  
4. Select EnergySaveSettings and then press the OK button.  
5. Select Auto power off and then press the OK button.  
6. Select a time to turn off the printer and then press the OK button.  
Turning on Printer Automatically  
You can enable the printer to turn on automatically when printing data is sent to the printer or the printer is  
operated for scanning from the computer.  
2. Press the Setup button.  
The Setup menu screen is displayed.  
3. Select ECO settings and then press the OK button.  
4. Select EnergySaveSettings and then press the OK button.  
5. Select Auto power on and then press the OK button.  
6. Select ON and then press the OK button.  
193  
     
Using Two-sided Printing  
Follow the procedure below to use duplex printing.  
2. Press the Setup button.  
The Setup menu screen is displayed.  
3. Select ECO settings and then press the OK button.  
4. Select 2-sidedPrintSetting and then press the OK button.  
5. Specify settings as necessary.  
Copy  
Select two-sided copying as a default.  
Template print  
Select two-sided printing of template forms on the printer as a default.  
FAX print  
Select two-sided printing of sent/received faxes, reports, or lists as a default.  
194  
 
Quiet setting  
Enables this function on the printer if you want to reduce the operating noise, such as when printing at night.  
In addition, you can specify the time range to reduce the operating noise.  
Important  
• Set the current date and time in advance.  
Follow the procedure below to perform setting.  
2. Press the Setup button.  
The Setup menu screen is displayed.  
3. Select Quiet mode and then press the OK button.  
4. Select Use or Specify hrs of use and then press the OK button.  
• When Use is selected:  
You can reduce the operating noise while printing is in progress.  
• When Specify hrs of use is selected:  
The screen to specify starting/ending time is displayed. Use the  
button to move the cursor  
under the desired position, use the Numeric buttons to enter the time, then press the OK button.  
You can reduce the operating noise during the specified time.  
Important  
• Operating speed may be reduced compared to when Do not use is selected.  
• This function may not be so effective depending on the printer's setting. Furthermore, certain  
noise, such as when the printer is preparing for printing, is not reduced.  
Note  
• You can set the quiet mode from the operation panel of the printer, the printer driver, or ScanGear  
(scanner driver). No matter how you set the quiet mode, the mode is applied when you perform  
operations from the operation panel of the printer or printing and scanning from the computer.  
195  
 
System information  
Select this menu from Setup menu.  
Current version  
Displays the current firmware version.  
Printer name  
Displays the printer name currently specified.  
Serial number  
Displays the printer serial number.  
196  
 
Specifications  
General Specifications  
Printing resolution (dpi)  
4800* (horizontal) x 1200 (vertical)  
* Ink droplets can be placed with a pitch of 1/4800 inch at minimum.  
Interface  
USB Port:  
Hi-Speed USB *  
LAN Port:  
Wi-Fi: IEEE802.11n / IEEE802.11g / IEEE802.11b  
* A computer that complies with Hi-Speed USB standard is required. Since the  
Hi-Speed USB interface is fully upwardly compatible with USB 1.1, it can be  
used at USB 1.1.  
USB and LAN can be used at the same time.  
Print width  
8 inches/203.2 mm  
(for Borderless Printing: 8.5 inches/216 mm)  
Printable area  
Borderless printing: Top/Bottom/Left/Right margin: 0.0 inch (0.0 mm)  
Standard printing:  
• Top margin:  
◦ 0.12 inch (3.0 mm)  
• Bottom margin:  
◦ 0.20 inch (5.0 mm)  
• Left margin:  
◦ Letter/Legal: 0.26 inch (6.4 mm)  
◦ Other sizes: 0.14 inch (3.4 mm)  
• Right margin:  
◦ Letter/Legal: 0.25 inch (6.3 mm)  
◦ Other sizes: 0.14 inch (3.4 mm)  
* For printable area of envelope, see below.  
Envelopes  
Auto duplex printing:  
• Top margin: 0.20 inch (5.0 mm)  
• Bottom margin: 0.20 inch (5.0 mm)  
• Left margin:  
◦ Letter: 0.26 inch (6.4 mm)  
◦ Other sizes: 0.14 inch (3.4 mm)  
• Right margin:  
◦ Letter: 0.25 inch (6.3 mm)  
197  
 
◦ Other sizes: 0.14 inch (3.4 mm)  
Operating environment  
Temperature: 41 to 95 °F (5 to 35 °C)  
Humidity: 10 to 90 % RH (no condensation)  
* The performance of the printer may be reduced under certain temperature  
and humidity conditions.  
Recommended conditions:  
Temperature: 59 to 86 °F (15 to 30 °C)  
Humidity: 10 to 80 % RH (no condensation)  
* For the temperature and humidity conditions of papers such as photo paper,  
refer to the paper's packaging or the supplied instructions.  
Storage environment  
Power supply  
Temperature: 32 to 104 °F (0 to 40 °C)  
Humidity: 5 to 95 % RH (no condensation)  
AC 100-240 V, 50/60 Hz  
(The supplied power cord is only for the country or region you purchased.)  
Power consumption  
Printing (Copy): 8 W or less *1  
Standby (minimum): 0.9 W or less *1*2  
OFF: 0.2 W or less  
*1 USB connection to PC  
*2 The wait time for standby cannot be changed.  
External dimensions  
Approx. 17.2 (W) x 11.7 (D) x 7.5 (H) inches  
Approx. 435 (W) x 295 (D) x 189 (H) mm  
* With the Cassette and trays retracted.  
Weight  
Approx. 13.0 lb (Approx. 5.9 kg)  
* With the FINE Cartridges installed.  
Canon FINE Cartridge  
ADF capacity  
Total 1280 nozzles (BK 320 nozzles, C/M/Y each 320 nozzles)  
2
A4 or Letter size: max. 20 sheets (20 lb/75 g /m paper), up to 0.08 inch/2 mm  
in height  
2
Legal size: max. 5 sheets (20 lb/75 g /m paper), up to 0.02 inch/0.5 mm in  
height  
Copy Specifications  
Multiple copy  
max. 99 pages  
Intensity adjustment  
Reduction / Enlargement  
9 positions, Auto intensity (AE copy)  
25 % - 400 % (1 % unit)  
198  
Scan Specifications  
Scanner driver  
Windows: TWAIN 1.9 Specification, WIA  
Maximum scanning size  
Platen: A4/Letter, 8.5" x 11.7"/216 x 297 mm  
ADF: A4/Letter/Legal, 8.5" x 14.0"/216 x 356 mm  
Optical resolution (horizontal x  
vertical)  
600 x 1200 dpi *  
* Optical Resolution represents the maximum sampling rate based on ISO  
14473.  
Gradation (Input / Output)  
Gray: 16 bit/8 bit  
Color: RGB each 16 bit/8 bit  
Fax Specifications  
Applicable line  
Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN)  
IP phone line (IP phone line with quality of no problem at all by using in conver-  
sation)  
Communication mode  
Super G3, G3  
Data compressing system  
Black: MH, MR, MMR  
Color: JPEG  
Modem speed  
max. 33.6 kbps  
(Automatic fallback)  
Transmission speed  
Black: Approx. 3 seconds/page at 33.6 kbps  
(Based on ITU-T No.1 chart for US specifications and Canon FAX Standard  
chart No.1 for others, both in standard mode.)  
Color: Approx. 1 minute/page at 33.6 kbps  
(Based on Canon COLOR FAX TEST SHEET.)  
Gradation  
Black: 256 levels  
Color: 24 bit Full Color (RGB each 8 bit)  
Density adjustment  
Memory  
3 levels  
Transmission/reception: approx. 50 pages  
(Based on ITU-T No.1 chart for US specifications and Canon FAX Standard  
chart No.1 for others, both in standard mode.)  
Fax resolution  
Black Standard: 203 pels/inch x 98 lines/inch (8 pels/mm x 3.85 lines/mm)  
Black Fine, Photo: 203 pels/inch x 196 lines/inch (8 pels/mm x 7.70 lines/mm)  
Black Extra fine: 300 x 300 dpi  
Color: 200 x 200 dpi  
Dialing  
Automatic dialing  
199  
• Recipient (max. 20 destinations)  
• Group dial (max. 19 destinations)  
Regular dialing (with Numeric buttons)  
Automatic redialing  
Manual redialing (max. 10 destinations)  
Others  
Activity report (after every 20 transactions)  
Sequential broadcasting (max. 21 destinations)  
Rejected numbers (max. 10 destinations)  
Err reduction (VoIP) *  
* For details, see "Err reduction (VoIP)" in "Adv. FAX settings".  
Network Specifications  
Communication protocol  
Wi-Fi  
TCP/IP  
Supported Standards: IEEE802.11n / IEEE802.11g / IEEE802.11b  
Frequency bandwidth: 2.4 GHz  
Channel: 1-11 or 1-13  
* Frequency bandwidth and available channels differ depending on country or  
region.  
Communication distance: Indoors 164 feet/50 m  
* Effective range varies depending on the installation environment and location.  
Security:  
WEP (64/128 bits)  
WPA-PSK (TKIP/AES)  
WPA2-PSK (TKIP/AES)  
Setup:  
WPS (Push button configuration/PIN code method)  
WCN (WCN-NET)  
Easy wireless connect  
Other Features: Administration password  
Minimum System Requirements  
Conform to the operating system's requirements when higher than those given here.  
Windows  
Operating System  
Windows 10, Windows 8.1, Windows 7 SP1  
Note: Operation can only be guaranteed on a PC with pre-installed Windows  
7 or later.  
200  
Hard Disk Space  
3.0 GB or more  
Note: For bundled software installation.  
The necessary amount of hard disk space may be changed without notice.  
Display  
XGA 1024 x 768  
macOS  
Operating System  
Hard Disk Space  
OS X 10.10.5 - OS X 10.11, macOS 10.12 - macOS 10.13  
1.5 GB or more  
Note: For bundled software installation.  
The necessary amount of hard disk space may be changed without notice.  
Display  
XGA 1024 x 768  
Other Supported OS  
iOS, Android, Windows 10 Mobile  
Some functions may not be available with the supported OS.  
Refer to the Canon web site for details.  
Mobile Printing Capability  
Apple AirPrint  
Google Cloud Print  
PIXMA Cloud Link  
Windows 10 Mobile Print  
Mopria Print Service  
• Internet connection or CD-ROM drive is required to install the software for Windows.  
• Internet connection is required to use Easy-WebPrint EX and/or Easy-PhotoPrint Editor and all the  
user's guide.  
• Easy-WebPrint EX: Internet Explorer 8, 9, 10 and 11 (for Windows) is required.  
• Windows: Some functions may not be available with Windows Media Center.  
• Windows: The TWAIN driver (ScanGear) is based on the TWAIN 1.9 Specification and requires the  
Data Source Manager bundled with the operating system.  
• macOS: For macOS, an internet connection is required during software installation.  
• In an in-house network environment, the 5222 port must be open. Contact the network  
administrator for details.  
Information in this manual is subject to change without notice.  
201  
Supported Media Types  
For best results, choose paper designed for how you are printing. A variety of paper for documents as well  
as photos or illustrations is available from Canon. Use genuine Canon paper to print important photos, when  
possible.  
Media Types  
Genuine Canon paper  
Note  
• For warnings on use of the non-printable side, see each product's usage information.  
• For details on page sizes and media types, access the Canon website.  
• Genuine Canon paper is not available in some countries or regions. Note that in the United States,  
Canon paper is not sold by model number. Instead, purchase paper by name.  
Paper for printing documents:  
• Canon Red Label Superior <WOP111>  
• Canon Océ Office Colour Paper <SAT213>  
• High Resolution Paper <HR-101N>*1  
Paper for printing photos:  
• Photo Paper Pro Platinum <PT-101>  
• Glossy Photo Paper "Everyday Use" <GP-501>  
• Photo Paper Glossy <GP-701>  
• Photo Paper Plus Glossy II <PP-201/PP-301>  
• Photo Paper Pro Luster <LU-101>  
• Photo Paper Plus Semi-gloss <SG-201>  
• Matte Photo Paper <MP-101>  
Paper other than genuine Canon paper  
• Plain Paper (including recycled paper)  
• Envelopes*1  
• Greeting Card*1  
*1 Printing to this paper from the operation panel is not supported.  
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Media Type) (Windows)  
203  
   
Page Sizes  
You can use the following page sizes.  
Note  
• Page sizes and media types the printer supports differ depending on the OS you are using.  
Standard sizes:  
• Letter  
• Legal  
• A5  
• A4  
• B5  
• KG/4"x6"(10x15)  
• 5"x7"(13x18cm)  
• 8"x10"(20x25cm)  
• L(89x127mm)  
• 2L(127x178mm)  
• Hagaki  
• Hagaki 2  
• Envelope Com 10  
• Envelope DL  
• Nagagata 3  
• Nagagata 4  
• Yougata 4  
• Yougata 6  
Special sizes  
Special page sizes must be within the following limits:  
• Minimum size: 3.50 x 5.00 inches (89.0 x 127.0 mm)  
• Maximum size: 8.50 x 26.61 inches (215.9 x 676.0 mm)  
Paper Weight  
You can use paper in the following weight range.  
2
• 17 to 28 lb (64 to 105 g /m ) (plain paper other than genuine Canon paper)  
204  
Paper Load Limit  
Genuine Canon Paper  
Paper for printing documents:  
Media Name <Model No.>  
Cassette  
Approx. 100 sheets  
Approx. 80 sheets  
Approx. 80 sheets  
Paper Output Tray  
Approx. 50 sheets  
Approx. 40 sheets  
Approx. 40 sheets  
Canon Red Label Superior <WOP111>  
Canon Océ Office Colour Paper <SAT213>  
High Resolution Paper <HR-101N>*1  
Paper for printing photos:  
Media Name <Model No.>  
Cassette  
Paper Output Tray  
Photo Paper Pro Platinum <PT-101>*2  
A4, Letter, 8" x 10" (20 x 25  
cm): 10 sheets  
4" x 6" (10 x 15 cm): 20 sheets  
Glossy Photo Paper "Everyday Use" <GP-501>*2  
Photo Paper Glossy <GP-701>*2  
A4, Letter: 10 sheets  
4" x 6" (10 x 15 cm): 20 sheets  
A4, Letter: 10 sheets  
4" x 6" (10 x 15 cm): 20 sheets  
Photo Paper Plus Glossy II <PP-201/PP-301>*2  
A4, Letter, 5" x 7" (13 x 18  
cm), 8" x 10" (20 x 25 cm): 10  
sheets  
4" x 6" (10 x 15 cm): 20 sheets  
A4, Letter: 10 sheets  
Photo Paper Pro Luster <LU-101>*2  
Photo Paper Plus Semi-gloss <SG-201>*2  
A4, Letter, 5" x 7" (13 x 18  
cm), 8" x 10" (20 x 25 cm): 10  
sheets  
4" x 6" (10 x 15 cm): 20 sheets  
Matte Photo Paper <MP-101>  
A4, Letter: 10 sheets  
4" x 6" (10 x 15 cm): 20 sheets  
Paper other than Genuine Canon Paper  
Common Name  
Cassette  
Paper Output Tray  
Plain Paper (including recycled paper)*1  
Approx. 100 sheets  
(Legal: 10 sheets)  
Approx. 50 sheets  
(Legal: 10 sheets)  
Envelopes  
5 envelopes  
Greeting Card  
Letter: 1 sheet  
205  
 
*1 Normal feeding at maximum capacity may not be possible with some types of paper, or under very high  
or low temperature or humidity. In this case, load half the amount of paper or less.  
*2 Feeding from a loaded stack of paper may leave marks on the printed side or prevent efficient feeding.  
In this case, load one sheet at a time.  
*3 For best results in continuous printing, remove printed paper or envelopes from the paper output tray to  
avoid smearing or discoloration.  
206  
     
Unsupported Media Types  
Do not use the following types of paper. Using such paper will cause not only unsatisfactory results, but also  
the printer to jam or malfunction.  
• Folded, curled, or wrinkled paper  
• Damp paper  
2
• Paper that is too thin (weighing less than 17 lb (64 g /m ))  
2
• Paper that is too thick (plain paper weighing more than 28 lb (105 g /m ), except for Canon genuine  
paper)  
• Paper thinner than a postcard, including plain paper or notepad paper cut to a small size (when printing  
on paper smaller than A5)  
• Picture postcards  
• Postcards  
• Envelopes with a double flap  
• Envelopes with an embossed or treated surface  
• Envelopes whose gummed flaps are already moistened and adhesive  
• Any type of paper with holes  
• Paper that is not rectangular  
• Paper bound with staples or glue  
• Paper with an adhesive surface on the back such as label seal  
• Paper decorated with glitter, etc.  
207  
 
Handling Paper  
• Be careful not to rub or scratch the surfaces of any types of paper when handling.  
• Hold the paper as closely as possible to its edges and try not to touch the printing surface. The print  
quality may be degraded if the printing surface is smudged with sweat or oil that comes from your  
hands.  
• Do not touch the printed surface until the ink is dried. Even when the ink is dried, be careful not to touch  
the printed surface as much as possible when handling. Due to the nature of the pigment ink, the ink on  
the printed surface may be removed when being rubbed or scratched.  
• Take out only the necessary number of paper from the package, just before printing.  
• To avoid curling, when you do not print, put unused paper back into the package and keep it on a level  
surface. And also, store it avoiding heat, humidity, and direct sunlight.  
208  
 
Printing  
Printing from Computer  
Printing from Smartphone/Tablet  
Printing Using Operation Panel  
Paper Settings  
209  
 
Printing from Computer  
Printing from Application Software (Windows Printer Driver)  
210  
 
Printing  
This printer is compatible with the macOS standard printing system (AirPrint).  
You can start printing right away after connecting this printer to your Mac without installing any special  
software.  
Checking Your Environment  
First, check your environment.  
• AirPrint Operation Environment  
Mac running the latest version of OS  
• Requirement  
The Mac and the printer must be connected by one of the following methods:  
◦ Connected to the same network over a LAN  
◦ Connected directly without wireless router (Direct Connection)  
◦ Connected by USB  
Print from a Mac  
Note  
• If Auto power on is enabled, printer automatically turns itself on when receiving a print job.  
2. Load paper in printer  
3. Select paper size and paper type from printer  
Register the set paper size and paper type on the printer operation panel.  
For instructions, see "Paper Settings."  
4. Start printing from your application software  
The Print dialog opens.  
5. Select printer  
Select your model from the Printer list in the Print dialog.  
212  
 
Note  
• Click Show Details to switch the setup window to the detailed display.  
6. Check print settings  
Set items such as Paper Size to the appropriate size, as well as Media Type from Media & Quality of  
the pop-up menu.  
Select Auto Select for Media Type.  
Remove the Two-Sided check mark if you are not printing on both sides of the paper.  
Important  
• An error may occur if the paper size set in the print dialog is different from the paper size set on  
the printer. Select the correct items on the print dialog and the printer that correspond to the  
paper being printed.  
213  
• If printing paper such as photo paper and postcards that cannot be printed on both sides,  
uncheck the Two-Sided checkbox.  
Note  
• Use the Print dialog to set general print settings such as the layout and the print sequence.  
For information about print settings, refer to macOS help.  
7. Click Print  
The printer prints according to the specified settings.  
Note  
• It can take the Wi-Fi a few minutes to get connected after the printer turns on. Print after checking  
that the printer is connected to the network.  
• You cannot print if Bonjour settings of printer are disabled. Check LAN settings of printer and enable  
Bonjour settings.  
• Refer to "Cannot Print Using AirPrint" for printing problems.  
• The display of the settings screen may differ depending on the application software you are using.  
Printing of Envelopes  
For printing on the envelope from Mac, refer to the following.  
Print result image  
Orientation of print data  
Orientation of loading envelope  
The print data is rotated by 180 degrees  
against the print result image.  
Load the envelope in vertically with the address side  
facing up so that the folded flap of the envelope will  
be faced down on the right side.  
214  
Printing on Postcards  
This section describes the procedure for printing on postcards.  
1. Load postcards in printer  
2. Select paper size and paper type from the printer  
Register Hagaki for paper size from the printer operation panel.  
Also, register Hagaki, IJ Hagaki, or Hagaki K for paper type, according to your purpose. When you print  
on the address side, register Hagaki.  
3. Select Paper Size and Media Type from the print dialog  
Select Postcard or Postcard Borderless for Paper Size from the print dialog. When you print on the  
address side, select Postcard.  
Select Auto Select for Media Type from the print dialog.  
Important  
• This printer cannot print on postcards that have photos or stickers attached.  
4. Uncheck Two-Sided  
215  
 
Important  
• Two-sided printing is not possible for postcards, so remove the Two-Sided check mark. If you  
print with the Two-Sided check mark on, the printing result may not be as you intended.  
• You will get cleaner printing if you print the message side first and then print the address side.  
5. Click Print  
The printer prints according to the specified settings.  
216  
Adding Printer  
Procedure for adding printer to your Mac is explained.  
To re-add a printer that was deleted, open System Preferences -> Printers & Scanners, click + next to the  
printer list, and then perform the procedure described below.  
If your printer is connected via USB, and you connect the USB cable to a Mac, the printer is automatically  
added. The below procedure is not necessary in this case.  
1. Check whether Default is selected in the displayed dialog  
Note  
• It may take a little time for the name of your printer to appear.  
2. Select the printer  
Select the printer listed as Bonjour Multifunction.  
Note  
• Check the following if printer does not appear.  
• Printer is on  
• Firewall function of the security software is off  
• Printer is either connected to the wireless router or directly connected to the PC (Direct  
Connection)  
3. Select Secure AirPrint from Use  
4. Click Add  
The printer is added to your Mac.  
217  
 
How to Open Printer Settings Screen  
The settings screen of the printer can be displayed from your application software.  
Opening the Page Setup Dialog  
Use this procedure to set the page (paper) settings before printing.  
1. Select Page Setup... from the File menu of the application software  
The Page Setup dialog opens.  
Opening the Print Dialog  
Use this procedure to set the print settings before printing.  
1. Select Print... from the File menu of the application software  
The Print dialog opens.  
218  
 
Displaying the Printing Status Screen  
Check the print progress according to the following procedure:  
1. Launch the printing status screen  
• If the print data has been sent to the printer  
The printing status screen opens automatically. To display the printing status screen, click the  
(the printer icon) displayed on the Dock.  
• If the print data has not been sent to the printer  
Open System Preferences, and select Printers & Scanners.  
To display the printing status screen, select the name of your printer model from the printer list,  
and then click Open Print Queue....  
2. Check the printing status  
You can check the name of the file being printed or ready for being printed.  
Deletes the specified print job.  
Stops printing the specified document.  
Resumes printing the specified document.  
Stops printing all documents.  
Displayed only when printing of all documents is being stopped, and resumes printing all docu-  
ments.  
Important  
• If an error occurs, an error message will appear on the printing progress confirmation screen.  
• The content of the error message may differ depending on the OS version.  
• The printer part names in the error message may differ from what is listed in this manual.  
• If the content of the error message is difficult to understand, check the error message displayed on the  
printer operation panel.  
219  
 
Deleting the Undesired Print Job  
If the printer does not start printing, canceled or failed print job data may be remaining.  
Delete unnecessary print jobs from the print status check screen.  
1. Open System Preferences, and select Printers & Scanners  
2. Select your model, and then click Open Print Queue...  
The print status check screen appears.  
3. Select the unnecessary print job and click  
(Delete)  
The selected print jobs will be deleted.  
220  
 
Removing Printer That Is No Longer Required from List of  
Printers  
The printer that is no longer in use can be removed from the list of printers.  
Before removing the printer, remove the cable connecting the printer and PC.  
You cannot remove the printer if not logged in as the administrator. For information about an administrative  
user, see Users & Groups from System Preferences.  
1. Open System Preferences, and select Printers & Scanners  
2. Delete printer from list of printers  
Select the printer you wish to remove from the list of printers and click -.  
Click Delete Printer when the confirmation message appears.  
221  
 
Printing Using Canon Application Software  
Easy-PhotoPrint Editor Guide  
222  
 
Printing Using a Web Service  
Using PIXMA/MAXIFY Cloud Link  
Printing with Google Cloud Print  
223  
 
Printing from Smartphone/Tablet  
Printing from iPhone/iPad/iPod touch (iOS)  
Printing from Smartphone/Tablet (Android)  
Printing from Windows 10 Mobile Device  
224  
 
Printing/Scanning with Wireless Direct  
You can connect devices (e.g. computer, smartphone, or tablet) to the printer by two methods below.  
• Wireless connection (connecting devices via a wireless router)  
• Direct wireless connection (connecting devices using Wireless Direct)  
This section describes Wireless Direct, which allows you to print or scan by connecting the devices to the  
printer directly.  
Follow the procedure below to use Wireless Direct.  
1. Preparing the printer.  
2. Preparing a device to connect to the printer.  
3. Printing/Scanning.  
Important  
• You can connect up to 5 devices to the printer at the same time.  
• Check the usage restrictions and switch the printer to the Wireless Direct.  
Changing Printer Setting to Use Wireless Direct  
2. Press the Setup button.  
The Setup menu screen is displayed.  
3. Select Device settings and then press the OK button.  
4. Select LAN settings and then press the OK button.  
5. Select Wireless Direct and then press the OK button.  
6. Select Switch WL Direct and then press the OK button.  
7. Select Yes and then press the OK button.  
When the setting is completed, the Wireless router info screen is displayed.  
8. Select Done and then press the OK button.  
225  
   
The Wireless Direct is enabled and a device can be connected to the printer wirelessly.  
Note  
• You can check the following on the Wireless router info screen. Use the  
button to select  
an item you want to check and then press the OK button.  
Network name(SSID): Identifier  
Security protocol: Security setting and password  
WL Direct dev. name: Printer name displayed on a Wi-Fi Direct compatible device  
The password is required when connecting a device to the printer. Depending on the device you  
are using, no password is required.  
When you connect a Wi-Fi Direct compatible device to the printer, select the printer name from  
your device.  
• For details on how to update the identifier (SSID) and the security setting, refer to the following.  
Changing Settings of a Device and Connecting It to the Printer  
1. Turn on Wi-Fi function on your device.  
Enable "Wi-Fi" on your device's "Setting" menu.  
For more on turning on Wi-Fi function, see your device's instruction manual.  
2. Select "DIRECT-XXXX-TR4500series" ("X" represents alphanumeric characters) from list  
displayed on your device.  
Note  
• If "DIRECT-XXXX-TR4500series" does not appear on the list, Wireless Direct is not enabled.  
See Changing Printer Setting to Use Wireless Direct to enable Wireless Direct.  
3. Enter password.  
Your device is connected to the printer.  
Note  
• You can check the password by printing the network settings from the printer.  
• Depending on the device you are using, no password is required.  
• If your Wi-Fi Direct compatible device is set to prioritize using Wi-Fi Direct and it is connecting  
to the printer, the printer displays a confirmation screen asking if you allow the device to  
connect to the printer.  
Make sure the name on the LCD is the same as that of your wireless communication device  
and select Yes and press the OK button.  
226  
 
Printing/Scanning with Wireless Direct  
After connecting a device and the printer, start printing/scanning from the application of your device.  
Note  
• For more on printing or scanning from a device via Wi-Fi, refer to the device's or application's  
instruction manual.  
• You can print/scan from your smartphone or tablet by installing Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY.  
Download it from App Store and Google Play.  
For iOS  
For Android  
Changing Wireless Direct Setting  
Change the settings for the Wireless Direct following the procedure below.  
2. Press the Setup button.  
The Setup menu screen is displayed.  
3. Select Device settings and then press the OK button.  
4. Select LAN settings and then press the OK button.  
5. Select Wireless Direct and then press the OK button.  
6. Select a setting item and then press the OK button.  
Change name (SSID)  
Updates the identifier (SSID) for Wireless Direct or the printer name displayed on a Wi-Fi Direct  
compatible device.  
Manual setup  
1. Select Manual setup and then press the OK button.  
2. Enter new printer name and then press the OK button.  
3. Confirm your entries and press the OK button.  
Auto update  
1. Select Auto update and then press the OK button.  
2. Select Yes and then press the OK button.  
3. Select Done and then press the OK button.  
If you select Network name(SSID) and press the OK button, you can check the updated  
identifier (SSID).  
227  
   
Change password  
Manual setup  
1. Select Manual setup and then press the OK button.  
2. Enter new password and then press the OK button.  
Auto update  
1. Select Auto update and then press the OK button.  
2. Select Yes and then press the OK button.  
3. Select Done and then press the OK button.  
If you select Security protocol instead of Done, you can check the updated password.  
Confirm request  
To display the confirmation screen when a Wi-Fi Direct compatible device is connecting to the  
printer, select Yes and press the OK button.  
Important  
• To prevent an unauthorized access, we recommend you should not change the setting from  
the default.  
Note  
• If you change the Wireless Direct setting of the printer, also change the wireless router setting of the  
device.  
228  
Paper Settings  
By registering the paper size and the media type loaded in the cassette, you can prevent the printer from  
misprinting by displaying the message before printing starts when the paper size or the media type of the  
loaded paper differs from the paper settings for printing.  
Note  
• The default setting is different between when you print/copy from the operation panel, when you print  
from Smartphone/tablet, when you print from Windows, and when you print from macOS.  
When you insert the cassette with paper loaded:  
The screen to register the paper information is displayed.  
Register the paper size and the media type according to the loaded paper.  
Important  
• For more on the proper combination of paper settings you can specify by the printer driver for  
Windows and on the LCD:  
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Media Type)  
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Paper Size)  
When the paper settings for printing/copying are different from the  
paper information registered in the printer:  
Ex:  
• Paper settings for printing/copying: A5  
• Paper information registered in the printer: A4  
229  
 
When you start printing/copying, The size/type of loaded paper is different from the print settings  
appears on the LCD.  
When you press the OK button, the screen for selecting the processing method is displayed. Please  
choose one of the following.  
Note  
• Depending on the setting, the choices below may not be displayed.  
Use cass. settings  
Select if you want to print on the paper loaded without changing the paper settings.  
For example, when the paper size setting for printing/copying is A5 and the paper information  
registered in the printer is A4, the printer starts printing/copying on the paper loaded in the cassette  
without changing the paper size setting for printing/copying.  
Replace the paper  
Select if you want to print after replacing the paper of the cassette.  
For example, when the paper size setting for printing/copying is A5 and the paper information  
registered in the printer is A4, you load A5 sized paper before you start printing/copying.  
After replacing the paper and pushing the cassette back, the paper information registration screen  
appears. Register the paper information in the printer in accordance with the paper loaded in the  
cassette.  
Note  
• For more on the proper combination of paper settings you can specify by the printer driver for  
Windows and on the LCD:  
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Media Type)  
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Paper Size)  
Cancel  
Cancels printing.  
Select when you change the paper settings specified for printing/copying. Change the paper settings  
and try printing/copying again.  
230  
Default Setting for Displaying the Message which Prevents Misprinting  
When you print/copy using the operation panel of the printer or when you print from  
smartphone/tablet:  
The message which prevents misprinting is enabled by default.  
To change the setting:  
When you print from Windows:  
The message which prevents misprinting is disabled by default.  
To change the setting:  
Changing the Printer Operation Mode  
When you print from macOS:  
The message which prevents misprinting is enabled by default.  
To change the setting:  
Important  
• When the message which prevents misprinting is disabled:  
The printer starts printing/copying even though the paper settings for printing/copying and the paper  
information registered in the printer are different.  
231  
 
Copying  
Reducing/Enlarging Copies  
Making Copies Basics  
Two-Sided Copying  
Special Copy Menu  
Collated Copying  
Copying Using Smartphone or Tablet  
232  
 
Making Copies  
This section describes the basic procedure to perform standard copying.  
3. Press the COPY button.  
The Copy standby screen is displayed.  
5. Confirm the page size (A) and magnification (B).  
Note  
• To change or confirm the page size, magnification, or other settings, press the Menu/Wireless  
connect button, then use the  
button to display the desired setting item.  
• Press the COPY button to reset the magnification to 100%.  
6. Use the  
button or the Numeric buttons to specify the number of copies.  
7. Press the Color button for color copying, or the Black button for black & white copying.  
The printer starts copying.  
Remove the original on the platen or from the document output slot after copying is complete.  
Important  
• If you load the original on the platen, do not open the document cover or remove the original while  
Scanning... is displayed on the screen.  
• If you load the original in the ADF, do not move the original until copying is complete.  
Note  
• To cancel copying, press the Stop button.  
• If you load the original on the platen, you can add the copying job while printing.  
233  
 
Adding the Copying Job (Reserve copy)  
If you load the original on the platen, you can add the copying job while printing (Reserve copy).  
The screen like shown below is displayed when you can reserve copy.  
Load the original on the platen and press the same button (the Color button or the Black button) as the  
one which you previously pressed.  
Important  
• When you load the original on the platen, open and close the document cover gently.  
Note  
• When Print quality is set High, or you load the original in the ADF, you cannot add the copying job.  
• When you add the copying job, the number of copies or the settings such as the page size or media  
type cannot be changed.  
• If you press the Stop button while reserve copying is in progress, the screen to select the method to  
cancel copying is displayed. If you select Cancel all reserv. then press the OK button, you can  
cancel copying all scanned data. If you select Cancel last reserv. then press the OK button, you can  
cancel the last copying job.  
• If you set a document of too many pages to reserve copy, Memory is full may appear on the LCD.  
Press the OK button and wait a while, then try copying again.  
• If Try again appears on the LCD when scanning, press the OK button, then press the Stop button to  
cancel copying. After that, copy the documents that have not been finished copying.  
234  
 
Setting Items for Copying  
You can change the copy settings such as the page size, media type, and intensity.  
In the copy mode, press the Menu/Wireless connect button, use the  
button to select a setting item,  
then press the OK button.  
Use the  
button to adjust each setting item, then press the OK button. The next setting item is  
displayed.  
The LCD returns to the Copy standby screen when all the settings are complete.  
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
• Some settings cannot be specified in combination with the setting of other setting items or the copy  
menu.  
• The settings of the page size, media type, etc. are retained even if the printer is turned off.  
Enlarge/Reduce  
Select the reduction/enlargement method.  
Reducing/Enlarging Copies  
Ex:  
Note  
• This setting item is displayed under the following conditions.  
• When standard copying is selected  
• When Borderless copy is selected for Special copy  
Copy intensity  
Change the intensity (brightness).  
Ex:  
Note  
• If you select Auto adjust, load the original on the platen.  
• If you select Manual adjust, use the  
button to decrease the intensity or the  
button to  
increase it.  
Page size  
Select the page size of the loaded paper.  
Ex:  
235  
 
Note  
• Some of setting items are not available depending on the country or region of purchase.  
Media type  
Select the media type of the loaded paper.  
Ex:  
Print quality  
Select the print quality according to the original.  
Ex:  
Note  
• If you use Draft with the media type set to Plain paper and the quality is not as good as expected,  
select Standard or High and try copying again.  
• Select High to copy in grayscale. Grayscale renders tones in a range of grays instead of black or  
white.  
4-on-1 layout  
Select the layout when copying four original pages onto a single sheet of paper by reducing each image.  
Four different layouts are available.  
Ex:  
Note  
• This setting item is displayed only when 4-on-1 copy is selected for Special copy.  
Copying Four Pages onto Single Page  
Collate  
Select whether to obtain sorted printouts when making multiple copies of a multi-paged original.  
Collated Copying  
Ex:  
236  
Note  
• This setting item is displayed when standard copying is selected.  
2-sided  
Select whether to perform two-sided copying.  
Ex:  
Note  
• This setting item is displayed only when 2-sided copy is selected for Special copy.  
Two-Sided Copying  
Stapling side  
Select the orientation and the stapling side of the printed paper.  
Ex:  
Note  
• This setting item is displayed only when 2-sided copy is selected for Special copy.  
Two-Sided Copying  
237  
Scanning  
Scanning from Computer (Windows)  
Scanning from Computer (macOS)  
Scanning from Operation Panel  
Scanning Using Smartphone/Tablet  
238  
 
Scanning According to Item Type or Purpose (IJ Scan Utility  
Lite)  
Important  
• Available functions and settings vary depending on your scanner or printer.  
240  
 
IJ Scan Utility Lite Features  
Use IJ Scan Utility Lite to scan and save documents, photos, or other items at one time by simply clicking  
the corresponding icon.  
Important  
• The displayed items and available functions vary depending on your scanner or printer.  
Multiple Scanning Modes  
Auto allows for one click scanning with default settings for various items. Document will sharpen text in a  
document or magazine for better readability, and Photo is best suited for scanning photos.  
Note  
• For details on the IJ Scan Utility Lite main screen, see IJ Scan Utility Lite Main Screen.  
Save Scanned Images Automatically  
Scanned images are automatically saved to a preset folder. The folder can be changed as needed.  
Note  
• The default save folder is the Pictures folder.  
• For how to specify a folder, see Settings Dialog.  
Application Integration  
Scanned images can be sent to other applications. For example, display scanned images in your favorite  
graphics application, attach them to e-mails, or extract text from images.  
241  
 
Note  
• To set the applications to integrate with, see Settings Dialog.  
242  
Scanning Easily (Auto Scan)  
Auto Scan allows for automatic detection of the type of the item placed on the platen or ADF (Auto  
Document Feeder).  
Important  
• This function is not supported depending on your model.  
• The following types of items may not be scanned correctly. In that case, adjust the cropping frames  
(selection boxes; scan areas) in the screen displayed by clicking Driver in the IJ Scan Utility Lite main  
screen, and then scan again.  
• Photos with a whitish background  
• Items printed on white paper, hand-written text, business cards, and other unclear items  
• Thin items  
• Thick items  
• When scanning two or more documents from the ADF, place documents of the same size.  
1. Check that scanner or printer is turned on.  
2. Place items on platen or ADF.  
3. Start IJ Scan Utility Lite.  
4. Click Auto.  
Scanning starts.  
Note  
• To cancel the scan, click Cancel.  
• Use the Settings (Auto Scan) dialog to set where to save the scanned images and to make advanced  
scan settings.  
• To scan a specific item type, see the following pages.  
Scanning with Favorite Settings  
243  
 
Scanning Multiple Documents at One Time from the ADF (Auto Document Feeder)  
244  
Scanning Documents and Photos  
Scan items placed on the platen with settings suitable for documents or photos.  
Save documents in formats such as PDF and JPEG, and photos in formats such as JPEG and TIFF.  
1. Place the item on the platen.  
2. Start IJ Scan Utility Lite.  
3. To specify the paper size, resolution, PDF settings, etc., click Settings..., and then set each  
item in the Settings dialog.  
Note  
• Once settings are made in the Settings dialog, the same settings can be used for scanning from  
the next time.  
• In the Settings dialog, specify image processing settings such as slant correction, set where to  
save the scanned images, and more, as needed.  
When setting is completed, click OK.  
4. Click Document or Photo.  
Scanning starts.  
Note  
• To cancel the scan, click Cancel.  
245  
 
Positioning Originals (Scanning from Computer)  
This section describes how to load originals on the platen or ADF (Auto Document Feeder) for scanning. If  
items are not placed correctly they may not be scanned correctly.  
Important  
• Be sure to observe the following when loading the original on the platen. Failure to observe the  
following may cause the scanner to malfunction or the platen glass to break.  
• Do not place any objects weighing 4.4 lb (2.0 kg) or more on the platen glass.  
• Do not put any pressure of 4.4 lb (2.0 kg) or more on the platen glass, such as pressing down the  
original.  
• Close the document cover when scanning.  
• Do not touch the operation panel buttons or LCD (Liquid Crystal Display) when opening/closing the  
document cover. May result in unintended operation.  
• When using a personal scanner in the upright position, the item type may not be detected automatically.  
In that case, specify the item type in IJ Scan Utility and scan.  
Placing Items (Platen)  
Place items as described below to scan by detecting the item type and size automatically.  
Important  
• Depending on your model, the function to scan by automatically detecting the item type and size  
does not appear.  
• When scanning by specifying the paper size, align an upper corner of the item with the corner at the  
arrow (alignment mark) of the platen.  
• Photos that have been cut to irregular shapes and items smaller than 1.2 inches (3 cm) square  
cannot be cropped accurately when scanning.  
• Reflective disc labels may not be scanned as expected.  
• If scanned by detecting the item type and size automatically, the response may differ. In that case,  
adjust the cropping frame (selection box) manually.  
Photos, Postcards, Business Cards, and BD/DVD/CD  
Magazines, Newspapers, and Documents  
Place the item face-down on the platen and align an  
upper corner of the item with the corner at the arrow  
(alignment mark) of the platen. Portions placed on  
the diagonally striped area cannot be scanned.  
Single item:  
Place the item face-down on the platen, with 0.4 inch (1 cm)  
or more space between the edges (diagonally striped area)  
247  
   
of the platen and the item. Portions placed on the diagonally  
striped area cannot be scanned.  
Important  
Inkjet All-In-One printer:  
Important  
For the portions in which items cannot be scan-  
ned, click Home to return to the top page of the  
Online Manual for your model and search for  
"Loading Originals."  
• Large items (such as A4 size photos) that cannot be  
placed away from the edges/arrow (alignment mark) of  
the platen may be saved as PDF files. To save in a for-  
mat other than PDF, scan by specifying the data format.  
Personal scanner:  
Multiple items:  
For the portions in which items cannot be scan-  
ned, click Home to return to the top page of the  
Online Manual for your model and search for  
"Items You Can Place & How to Place Items."  
Allow 0.4 inch (1 cm) or more space between the edges (di-  
agonally striped area) of the platen and items, and between  
items. Portions placed on the diagonally striped area cannot  
be scanned.  
: 0.4 inch (1 cm) or more  
Note  
• In IJ Scan Utility Lite, place up to 12 items.  
• Positions of slanted items (10 degrees or less) are cor-  
rected automatically.  
Placing Documents (ADF (Auto Document Feeder))  
Important  
• Do not leave thick items on the platen when scanning from the ADF. May result in paper jam.  
• Place and align documents of the same size when scanning two or more documents.  
• For supported document sizes when scanning from the ADF, click Home to return to the top page of  
the Online Manual for your model and search for "Supported Originals."  
248  
 
1. Make sure any original has been removed from platen.  
2. Open document tray (A).  
3. Slide the paper guides (B) all the way out.  
4. Load document with side to scan facing up in document tray.  
Insert the document until it stops.  
5. Adjust document guide (B) to match width of document.  
Do not slide the document guide too hard against the document. The document may not be fed  
properly.  
Note  
• When scanning duplex documents, place the front sides facing up. They will not be scanned correctly  
if placed the other way around.  
Placing Items (When Using Stand)  
1. Place item on platen.  
1. Open the document cover.  
249  
 
2. Place the item with the side to scan facing the platen, and then align it with the alignment  
mark.  
Important  
• If you open the document cover wide, the scanner may fall over.  
• Portions placed over (A) (0.094 inch (2.4 mm) from the left edge of the platen) or (B) (0.106 inch  
(2.7 mm) from the front edge) cannot be scanned.  
2. Gently close document cover.  
While scanning, hold the document cover gently with your hand to keep it closed.  
Important  
• Keep these points in mind when using the scanner in the upright position.  
• Do not subject the scanner to vibration during operation. The correct image results may not  
be obtained (for example, images may blur).  
250  
• The item type may not be detected automatically. In that case, specify the item type in IJ  
Scan Utility and scan.  
251  
Scanning Using Smartphone/Tablet  
Using PIXMA/MAXIFY Cloud Link  
252  
 
Faxing  
Preparing for Faxing  
Registering Recipients  
Sending Faxes from Computer (Windows)  
Sending Faxes Using Operation Panel of  
Printer  
Sending Faxes from Computer (Mac OS)  
Receiving Faxes  
Other Useful Fax Functions  
253  
 
Preparing for Faxing  
Connect the printer to the telephone line and set up the printer before using the faxing functions. Then  
specify the basic setting such as sender information, date/time, and daylight saving time.  
Important  
• If the Power Disconnects:  
If there is a power failure or if you accidentally unplug the power cord, the date/time settings will be  
reset.  
• The settings for user information and directory will be retained.  
• All faxes stored in the printer's memory, such as unsent and received faxes, will be lost.  
If the power disconnects, the following will apply:  
• You will not be able to send or receive faxes, make copies, or scan originals.  
• When you are connecting the telephone, whether or not you can use it depends upon your  
telephone line or telephone.  
Setting Up Printer  
The printer must be set up depending on your telephone line and use of the faxing function.  
All Setup  
FAX Setup Guide  
Individual Setup  
Step1  
Step2  
Step3  
Step4  
Note  
• You can set the fax setting according to the instruction on the LCD.  
If you set up according to the instruction on the LCD, the receive mode is set to TEL priority mode  
or Fax only mode. To receive faxes with DRPD or Network switch, change the receive mode.  
254  
 
Connecting Telephone Line  
The connection method differs depending on your telephone line.  
• If you connect the printer to wall telephone line directly/If you connect the printer with the xDSL splitter:  
• If you connect the printer to another line such as an xDSL:  
If the connection is incorrect, the printer cannot send/receive faxes. Connect the printer correctly.  
Important  
• Do not connect fax devices and/or telephones in parallel (US and Canada only).  
If two or more fax devices and/or telephones are connected in parallel, the following problems may  
occur and the printer may not operate properly.  
• If you pick up the handset of the telephone that is connected in parallel during fax transmission or  
reception, the fax image may be corrupted or a communication error may occur.  
• Such services as Caller ID, etc. may not operate properly on the telephone.  
If you cannot avoid parallel connections, set the receive mode to TEL priority mode, understanding  
that the above problems may occur. You will only be able to receive faxes manually.  
Basic Connection (Connecting with General Telephone line)  
Make sure that the printer is turned off, connect one end of supplied telephone line cable to the telephone  
line jack near the "LINE" mark of the printer, then connect the other end to the telephone line jack on the  
wall or to the telephone line jack of the xDSL splitter.  
When you connect the telephone to the printer, make sure that the printer is turned off, connect one end  
of the modular cable to the external device jack near the "EXT." mark of the printer, then connect the other  
end to the telephone line jack of the telephone.  
255  
   
Important  
• Be sure to connect the telephone line before the printer is turned on.  
If you connect the telephone line when the printer is turned on, turn the printer off and unplug the  
power cord. Wait for 1 minute then connect the telephone line and power plug.  
Note  
• Refer to Rear View for the position of the telephone line jack and the external device jack.  
• Before connecting a telephone or answering machine, remove the Telephone connector cap.  
For users in the UK:  
If the connector of the external device cannot be connected to the jack on the printer, you will need to  
purchase a B.T. adapter to connect as follows:  
Attach the B.T. adapter to the modular cable connecting the external device, then connect the B.T.  
adapter to the external device jack.  
Connecting Various Lines  
This section introduces how to connect various lines.  
These are examples and could not be guaranteed to suit every connecting condition. For details, refer to  
the instruction manual supplied with the network device (control devices such as an xDSL (Digital  
Subscriber Line) modem or terminal adapter) you are connecting to this printer.  
Note  
• xDSL is the generic term for the high speed digital communication technology with telephone line  
such as ADSL/HDSL/SDSL/VDSL.  
256  
 
Connecting to an Internet Telephone  
A: Digital Subscriber Line  
B: xDSL modem (splitter may not be built-in to the modem)  
C: Broadband router compatible with Internet Telephone  
D: Computer  
E: Telephone or answering machine  
F: WAN (Wide Area Network) port  
G: LAN (Local Area Network) port  
H: TEL port  
I: LINE port  
* Port configurations and names may vary depending on the product.  
Note  
• When connecting to the xDSL line, select the same line type as you are subscribing to in  
Telephone line type.  
Connecting to an xDSL  
A: Analog Subscriber Line  
B: xDSL modem (splitter may not be built-in to the modem)  
C: Computer  
D: Telephone or answering machine  
Important  
• When the splitter is not built-in to the modem, do not branch the telephone line before the splitter  
(wall side). And also, do not connect splitters in parallel. The printer may not be able to operate  
properly.  
Note  
• When connecting to the xDSL line, select the same line type as you are subscribing to in  
Telephone line type.  
257  
Connecting to an ISDN Line  
For details on ISDN (Integrated Service Digital Network) connection and settings, refer to the manuals  
supplied with your terminal adapter or dial-up router.  
258  
Setting Telephone Line Type  
Before using your printer, make sure you set the correct telephone line type for your telephone line. If you  
are unsure of your telephone line type, contact your telephone company. For xDSL or ISDN connections,  
contact the telephone company or service provider to confirm your line type.  
Important  
For users in China  
After plugging the power cord and turning on the printer, the telephone line type is selected  
automatically. However, if the printer is connected to the control device such as an xDSL modem or  
terminal adapter, the telephone line type may not be selected correctly.  
In this case, set the line type manually.  
For details on how to set the Telephone line type manually in China:  
Note  
Telephone line type will not appear in countries or regions where Rotary pulse is not supported.  
• You can print USER'S DATA LIST to check the current setting.  
Summary of Reports and Lists  
2. Press the Setup button.  
The Setup menu screen is displayed.  
3. Select Fax settings, then press the OK button.  
4. Select FAX user settings, then press the OK button.  
5. Select Telephone line type, then press the OK button.  
6. Select a telephone line type, then press the OK button.  
Rotary pulse  
Select when your telephone line type is pulse dialing.  
Touch tone  
Select when your telephone line type is tone dialing.  
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
259  
 
7. Press the FAX button to return to the Fax standby screen.  
Setting the Telephone Line Type Manually in China  
This section describes the procedure to set the telephone line type manually in China.  
2. Press the Setup button.  
The Setup menu screen is displayed.  
3. Select Fax settings, then press the OK button.  
4. Select FAX user settings, then press the OK button.  
5. Select TEL line auto select, then press the OK button.  
The current telephone line type is displayed.  
Note  
• If you do not need to change the telephone line type, press the FAX button to return to the Fax  
standby screen.  
6. Select OFF, then press the OK button.  
7. Select a telephone line type, then press the OK button.  
Rotary pulse  
Select when your telephone line type is pulse dialing.  
Touch tone  
Select when your telephone line type is tone dialing.  
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
8. Press the FAX button to return to the Fax standby screen.  
260  
 
Setting Receive Mode  
Set the receiving operation (receiving mode).  
For details on how to set the receive mode:  
You can select the appropriate mode.  
For details on the selectable receive mode:  
For details on the advanced settings of the receive mode:  
Note  
• The receiving operation procedure varies depending on the selected receive mode.  
For details on receiving method depending on each receive mode:  
• If you want to use a single telephone line for faxes and voice calls, you need to connect a telephone or  
an answering machine to the external device jack of this printer.  
For details on how to connect the telephone or the answering machine to the printer:  
Setting Receive Mode  
This section describes the procedure to select the receive mode.  
2. Press the FAX button.  
The Fax standby screen is displayed.  
3. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.  
The FAX menu screen is displayed.  
4. Select Receive mode set., then press the OK button.  
5. Select the receive mode, then press the OK button.  
The confirmation message for the advanced settings appears.  
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
• For details on the receive mode:  
261  
   
DRPD is available only in the US and Canada.  
Network switch may not be available depending on the country or region of purchase.  
• Refer to Receiving Faxes for information on receiving faxes or the procedure for each receive  
mode.  
6. If you make the advanced settings, select Yes and press the OK button. If not, select No  
and press the OK button.  
Make the advanced settings as necessary.  
About Receive Mode  
You can select the receive mode suitable for your fax use conditions: whether you use a dedicated line for  
fax, etc.  
TEL priority mode  
Select when mainly receiving voice calls (with a telephone or answering machine connected to the  
printer).  
Receiving operation:  
1. When a call incomes, the telephone will ring.  
2. Pick up the handset.  
If the call is a voice call, talk on the telephone.  
If the call is a fax, hang up the handset after the printer starts receiving the fax.  
Note  
• The telephone may not ring when a call incomes even if it is connected to the printer, depending  
on the type or settings of the telephone.  
DRPD or Network switch  
Select when receiving voice calls (with a telephone or answering machine connected to the printer)  
and subscribing to a ring pattern detection service provided by your telephone company.  
Receiving operation:  
1. When a call incomes, the telephone will ring.  
2. The printer detects a fax call by the fax ring pattern.  
If the call is a fax, the printer will receive the fax automatically.  
If the printer does not detect the fax ring pattern, the telephone will continue ringing.  
Note  
• The telephone may not ring when a call incomes even if it is connected to the printers, depending  
on the type or settings of the telephone.  
262  
 
Fax only mode  
Select when not receiving voice calls.  
Receiving operation:  
1. When a fax incomes, the printer will receive the fax automatically.  
Advanced Settings of Receive Mode  
You can specify the advanced settings of each receive mode.  
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
Advanced setting in TEL priority mode  
You can specify the following setting items.  
Manual/auto switch  
If you select ON, the printer automatically receives faxes after the external device rang a specified  
length of time.  
Use the  
button or the Numeric buttons to specify the length of time until automatic reception  
is started.  
User-friendly RX  
If you select ON, the printer automatically switches from telephone calling to fax reception by  
detecting the fax signal (CNG signal) when you lift the handset of the telephone or the answering  
machine answers. When you have an answering machine connected to the printer, select ON to  
switch to fax reception automatically after the answering machine answers.  
If you select OFF, the printer does not switch from telephone calling to fax reception automatically  
even if the printer detects the fax signal (CNG signal). Select OFF if you want the printer not to  
switch automatically during a call.  
Note  
• If you subscribe to Duplex Ringing service in Hong Kong, the number of times the external device  
rings specified with Incoming ring in Fax only mode is available in TEL priority mode.  
If you want to specify the number of times the external device rings in TEL priority mode, select  
Fax only mode for Receive mode set. under FAX menu, specify the number of times the  
external device rings with Incoming ring, then switch to TEL priority mode for Receive mode  
set..  
• If you subscribe to Duplex Ringing service in Hong Kong, we recommend that Manual/auto  
switch be set to OFF.  
Advanced setting in Fax only mode  
You can specify the following setting item.  
Incoming ring  
263  
 
Use the  
button or the Numeric buttons to specify the number of times the external device  
rings when incoming.  
Advanced setting in DRPD  
You can specify the following setting items.  
DRPD: FAX ring pat.  
Sets the distinctive ring pattern of a call that the printer assumes is a fax call.  
If you subscribe to a DRPD service, set the ring pattern to match the pattern assigned by your  
telephone company.  
Incoming ring  
You can specify the number of times the external device rings when incoming.  
Advanced setting in Network switch  
You can specify the following setting item.  
Incoming ring  
You can specify the number of times the external device rings when incoming.  
Setting the DRPD Ring Pattern (US and Canada only)  
If you have subscribed to a Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection (DRPD) service provided by your telephone  
company, your telephone company will assign two or more telephone numbers with distinctive ring  
patterns to your single telephone line, allowing you to have different numbers for fax calls and voice calls  
using only one telephone line. Your printer will automatically monitor the ring pattern, and will  
automatically receive the fax if the ring pattern is a fax call.  
To use DRPD, follow the procedure below to set the fax ring pattern that matches the pattern assigned by  
your telephone company.  
Note  
• Contact your local telephone company for detailed information on this service.  
2. Press the FAX button.  
The Fax standby screen is displayed.  
3. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.  
The FAX menu screen is displayed.  
4. Select Receive mode set., then press the OK button.  
5. Select DRPD, then press the OK button.  
264  
 
The confirmation screen asking whether to make advanced settings is displayed.  
6. Select Yes, then press the OK button.  
7. Select DRPD: FAX ring pat., then press the OK button.  
The DRPD: FAX ring pat. screen is displayed.  
8. Select the ring pattern that your telephone company assigned to your fax number, then  
press the OK button.  
Select from Normal ring, Double ring, Short-short-long, or Short-long-short.  
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
9. Press the FAX button to return to the Fax standby screen.  
265  
Setting Sender Information  
You can set the sender information such as user information and date/time.  
About Sender Information  
If the unit name and unit fax/telephone number are registered, they are printed with date and time as  
sender information on the recipient's fax.  
A: Date and time of transmission  
B: Unit fax/telephone number  
C: Unit name  
D: The registered recipient's name is printed when sending faxes.  
E: Page number  
Note  
• You can print USER'S DATA LIST to confirm the sender information you have registered.  
Summary of Reports and Lists  
• When sending faxes in black & white, you can select whether to print the sender information inside or  
outside the image area.  
Specify the setting on TTI position in Adv. FAX settings under Fax settings.  
• You can select the date print format from three formats: YYYY/MM/DD, MM/DD/YYYY, and DD/MM/  
YYYY.  
Select the date print format on Date display format under Other dev. settings.  
266  
   
Setting Date and Time  
This section describes the procedure to set the date and time.  
2. Press the Setup button.  
The Setup menu screen is displayed.  
3. Select Device settings, then press the OK button.  
4. Select Other dev. settings, then press the OK button.  
5. Select Date/time setting, then press the OK button.  
6. Set the date and time.  
Use the  
button to move the cursor under the desired position, then use the Numeric buttons to  
enter the date and time.  
Enter the time in 24-hour format.  
Enter only the last two digits of the year.  
7. Press the OK button.  
8. Press the FAX button to return to the Fax standby screen.  
Setting Daylight Saving Time (Summer Time)  
Some countries adopt the daylight saving time (summer time) system that shifts the clock time forward at  
certain periods of the year.  
You can set your printer to automatically change the time by registering the date and time that daylight  
saving time (summer time) begins and ends.  
Important  
• Not all the latest information of all countries or regions is applied for DST setting by default. You  
need to change the default setting according to the latest information of your country or region.  
Note  
• This setting may not be available depending on the country or region of purchase.  
267  
   
2. Press the Setup button.  
The Setup menu screen is displayed.  
3. Select Device settings, then press the OK button.  
4. Select Other dev. settings, then press the OK button.  
5. Select DST setting, then press the OK button.  
6. Select ON, then press the OK button.  
To disable summer time, select OFF.  
7. Set the date and time when summer time starts.  
1. Select Start date/time, then press the OK button.  
2. Make sure that Set month is selected, then press the OK button.  
3. Select the month when summer time starts, then press the OK button.  
4. Make sure that Set week is selected, then press the OK button.  
5. Select the week when summer time starts, then press the OK button.  
6. Make sure that Set day of week is selected, then press the OK button.  
7. Select the day of the week when summer time starts, then press the OK button.  
8. Make sure that Set shift time is selected, then press the OK button.  
9. Use the  
button to move the cursor under the desired position, use the Numeric buttons to  
enter the time (in 24-hour format) when summer time starts, then press the OK button.  
Precede single digits with a zero.  
8. Set the date and time when summer time ends.  
1. Use the  
button to select End date/time, then press the OK button.  
2. Make sure that Set month is selected, then press the OK button.  
3. Use the  
button to select the month when summer time ends, then press the OK button.  
4. Make sure that Set week is selected, then press the OK button.  
5. Use the  
button to select the week when summer time ends, then press the OK button.  
6. Make sure that Set day of week is selected, then press the OK button.  
7. Use the  
button to select the day of the week when summer time ends, then press the OK  
button.  
8. Make sure that Set shift time is selected, then press the OK button.  
268  
9. Use the  
button to move the cursor under the desired position, use the Numeric buttons to  
enter the time (in 24-hour format) when summer time ends, then press the OK button.  
Precede single digits with a zero.  
9. Press the FAX button to return to the Fax standby screen.  
Registering User Information  
This section describes the procedure to register the user information.  
Note  
• Before sending a fax, be sure to enter your name and fax/telephone number in Unit TEL no. registr.  
and Unit name registr. on the FAX user settings screen (for US only).  
2. Press the Setup button.  
The Setup menu screen is displayed.  
3. Select Fax settings, then press the OK button.  
4. Select FAX user settings, then press the OK button.  
5. Enter the unit fax/telephone number.  
1. Make sure that Unit TEL no. registr. is selected, then press the OK button.  
2. Use the Numeric buttons to enter the unit fax/telephone number.  
3. Press the OK button.  
Note  
• You can enter the fax/telephone number up to 20 digits, including spaces.  
• For details on how to enter or delete characters:  
6. Enter the unit name.  
1. Make sure that Unit name registr. is selected, then press the OK button.  
2. Use the Numeric buttons to enter the unit name.  
269  
 
3. Press the OK button.  
Note  
• You can enter the name up to 24 characters, including spaces.  
• For details on how to enter or delete characters:  
7. Press the FAX button to return to the Fax standby screen.  
270  
Registering Recipients  
Registering Recipients Using Speed Dial Utility2 (Windows)  
271  
 
Registering Recipients Using Operation Panel of Printer  
Registering recipients in the printer's directory in advance allows you to dial fax/telephone numbers simply.  
The following methods to register are available:  
• Recipient registration  
Registering the recipient's fax/telephone number and name allows you to send a fax by selecting a  
registered recipient in the printer directory.  
• Group dial registration  
You can combine two or more recipients registered in advance into a group. You can send the same  
document to all the registered recipients in the group.  
You can register up to 20 recipients in total of individual recipients and group dials.  
Note  
• To change the registered information of the recipient or the group dial, see Changing Registered  
• To delete the registered information of the recipient or the group dial, see Deleting Registered  
• To print a list of the recipient's fax/telephone numbers and names registered, see Printing List of  
• You can register, change, or delete the registered information of the recipient or the group dial using  
Speed Dial Utility on the computer.  
• For Windows:  
Registering Recipients Using Speed Dial Utility2 (Windows)  
• For macOS:  
272  
 
Registering Fax/Telephone Number of Recipients  
Before you can use the printer's directory, you need to register the recipients' fax/telephone numbers. Follow  
the procedure below to register the recipients' fax/telephone numbers.  
2. Press the FAX button.  
The Fax standby screen is displayed.  
3. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.  
The FAX menu screen is displayed.  
4. Select Directory, then press the OK button.  
5. Select Add directory entry, then press the OK button.  
Note  
• You can select Add directory entry from TEL no. registration in Fax settings after pressing the  
Setup button.  
6. Select Recipient, then press the OK button.  
The screen to select an ID number is displayed.  
7. Use the  
button or the Numeric buttons to select an unregistered ID number, then press  
the OK button.  
Note  
• If you already registered the recipient, the fax/telephone number is displayed next to the ID  
number. If you already registered the group dial, (Not available) is displayed.  
8. Select a registration method, then press the OK button.  
9. Register the recipients' fax/telephone number.  
From call log (OUT) is selected as the registration method:  
The screen to select the fax/telephone number from the outgoing call logs is displayed.  
1. Select a fax/telephone number, then press the OK button.  
273  
 
The fax/telephone number selected from the outgoing call logs is displayed.  
2. Check the fax/telephone number, then press the OK button.  
The fax/telephone number is registered to the printer and the screen to enter the recipient's  
name is displayed.  
From call log (IN) is selected as the registration method:  
The screen to select the fax/telephone number or the name from the incoming call logs is  
displayed.  
1. Select a fax/telephone number or a name, then press the OK button.  
The fax/telephone number selected from the incoming call logs is displayed.  
2. Check the fax/telephone number, then press the OK button.  
The fax/telephone number is registered to the printer and the screen to enter the recipient's  
name is displayed.  
Note  
• This registration method may not be available depending on the country or region of purchase.  
Direct entry is selected as the registration method:  
The screen to enter the fax/telephone number is displayed.  
1. Use the Numeric buttons to enter the fax/telephone number you want to register.  
2. Press the OK button.  
The fax/telephone number is registered to the printer and the screen to enter the recipient's  
name is displayed.  
Note  
• You can enter the fax/telephone number up to 60 digits (40 digits for the US, Canada,  
Korea and some regions of Latin America), including spaces.  
• Press the  
button twice to enter a pause.  
• When Telephone line type in FAX user settings under Fax settings is set to Rotary  
pulse, you can enter a tone ("T") by pressing the Tone button.  
10. Use the Numeric buttons to enter the recipient's name.  
274  
If you select a name on From call log (IN) in step 9, the name may be already entered. If you do not  
change the name, go to step 11.  
Note  
• You can enter the name up to 16 characters, including spaces.  
11. Press the OK button to finalize registration.  
Note  
• To register another recipient's number and name, select an unregistered ID number and operate  
in the same procedure.  
• To return to the Fax standby screen, press the FAX button.  
• You can check the recipient's numbers and names you have registered by printing RECIPIENT  
TELEPHONE NUMBER LIST.  
275  
Registering Recipients in Group Dial  
If you register two or more registered recipients to a group dial, you can send the same document  
successively to all recipients registered to the group dial.  
2. Press the FAX button.  
The Fax standby screen is displayed.  
3. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.  
The FAX menu screen is displayed.  
4. Select Directory, then press the OK button.  
5. Select Add directory entry, then press the OK button.  
Note  
• You can select Add directory entry from TEL no. registration in Fax settings after pressing the  
Setup button.  
6. Select Group dial, then press the OK button.  
The screen to select an ID number is displayed.  
7. Use the  
button or the Numeric buttons to select an unregistered ID number, then press  
the OK button.  
Note  
• If you already registered the recipient, (Not available) is displayed next to the ID number. If you  
already registered the group dial, the registered group name is displayed.  
The Group member screen is displayed.  
8. Register the registered recipient as a member of the group dial.  
1. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.  
2. Choose a recipient to register as a member.  
276  
 
You can choose a recipient with the two methods. The method can be switched by pressing the  
button.  
• When Add to group is displayed on the LCD:  
Use the  
button to select a recipient's ID number to register to the group dial.  
• When Enter first letter is displayed on the LCD:  
After you use the Numeric buttons to enter the first letter of the recipient's name you want to  
search, the registered recipients are displayed in alphabetical order.  
Use the  
button to select a recipient's ID number to register to the group dial.  
3. Press the OK button.  
The selected recipient is registered as a member of the group dial.  
4. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button to display the screen to select an ID number, then add  
another member.  
Repeat this step to register the other recipient to the same group dial.  
Note  
• You can check the recipient's ID number and name registered to the group dial by using the  
button.  
9. Press the OK button after finishing registering the member you want to register to the group  
dial.  
The screen to enter the group name is displayed.  
10. Use the Numeric buttons to enter the group name.  
Note  
• You can enter the name up to 16 characters, including spaces.  
277  
11. Press the OK button to finalize registration.  
Note  
• To register another group, select an unregistered ID number and operate in the same procedure.  
• To return to the Fax standby screen, press the FAX button.  
• You can check the recipients you have registered to the group dial by printing GROUP DIAL  
TELEPHONE NO. LIST.  
278  
Changing Registered Information  
To change information registered for recipient and group dial, follow the procedure below.  
2. Press the FAX button.  
The Fax standby screen is displayed.  
3. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.  
The FAX menu screen is displayed.  
4. Select Directory, then press the OK button.  
5. Select Add directory entry, then press the OK button.  
Note  
• You can select Add directory entry from TEL no. registration in Fax settings after pressing the  
Setup button.  
6. Change the registered information.  
• To change the recipient's information:  
1. Select Recipient, then press the OK button.  
2. Use the  
OK button.  
button or the Numeric buttons to select a recipient's ID number, then press the  
3. Select Edit, then press the OK button.  
The screen to select a registration method is displayed as well as when you register the  
recipient.  
4. Select a registration method, then press the OK button.  
5. Change the recipient's fax/telephone number.  
From call log (OUT) is selected as the registration method:  
The screen to select the fax/telephone number from the outgoing call logs is displayed.  
After you use the  
button to select a fax/telephone number and press the OK button,  
the editing screen is displayed. Change the recipient's fax/telephone number, then press  
the OK button.  
From call log (IN) is selected as the registration method:  
The screen to select the fax/telephone number or the name from the incoming call logs is  
displayed. After you use the  
button to select a fax/telephone number or a name and  
press the OK button, the editing screen is displayed. Change the recipient's fax/telephone  
number, then press the OK button.  
279  
 
Note  
• This registration method may not be available depending on the country or region of  
purchase.  
Direct entry is selected as the registration method:  
The editing screen is displayed. Change the recipient's fax/telephone number, then press  
the OK button.  
Note  
• You can enter the fax/telephone number up to 60 digits (40 digits for the US, Canada,  
Korea and some regions of Latin America), including spaces.  
• Press the  
button twice to enter a pause.  
• When Telephone line type in FAX user settings under Fax settings is set to Rotary  
pulse, you can enter a tone ("T") by pressing the Tone button.  
6. Change the recipient's name, then press the OK button.  
Note  
• You can enter the name up to 16 characters, including spaces.  
• To change a group dial:  
1. Select Group dial, then press the OK button.  
2. Use the  
button or the Numeric buttons to select an ID number of group dial to change,  
then press the OK button.  
3. Select Edit, then press the OK button.  
4. Edit the member of the group dial.  
To add a member, press the Menu/Wireless connect button to display the screen to select  
an ID number and then add another member.  
To delete a member, select a member to delete and then press the Tone button.  
5. Change the group name, then press the OK button.  
Note  
• You can enter the name up to 16 characters, including spaces.  
Note  
• To return to the Fax standby screen, press the FAX button.  
280  
Deleting Registered Information  
To delete information registered for recipient and group dial, follow the procedure below.  
2. Press the FAX button.  
The Fax standby screen is displayed.  
3. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.  
The FAX menu screen is displayed.  
4. Select Directory, then press the OK button.  
5. Select Add directory entry, then press the OK button.  
Note  
• You can select Add directory entry from TEL no. registration in Fax settings after pressing the  
Setup button.  
6. Delete the registered information.  
• To delete the recipient's information:  
1. Select Recipient, then press the OK button.  
2. Use the  
OK button.  
button or the Numeric buttons to select a recipient's ID number, then press the  
3. Select Delete, then press the OK button.  
4. Select Yes, then press the OK button.  
• To delete a group dial:  
1. Select Group dial, then press the OK button.  
2. Use the  
button or the Numeric buttons to select an ID number of group dial to delete,  
then press the OK button.  
3. Select Delete, then press the OK button.  
4. Select Yes, then press the OK button.  
Note  
• To return to the Fax standby screen, press the FAX button.  
281  
 
Printing List of Registered Destinations  
You can print a list of the fax/telephone numbers and can keep it near the printer to refer to when dialing.  
3. Press the FAX button.  
The Fax standby screen is displayed.  
4. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.  
The FAX menu screen is displayed.  
5. Select Print reports/lists, then press the OK button.  
6. Select Directory list, then press the OK button.  
7. Select an item to print, then press the OK button.  
• If you selected Recipient:  
The confirmation screen asking if you print the list alphabetically by name is displayed.  
If you select Yes and press the OK button, RECIPIENT TELEPHONE NUMBER LIST is printed in  
alphabetical order.  
If you select No and press the OK button, RECIPIENT TELEPHONE NUMBER LIST is printed in  
the order of the ID number.  
• If you selected Group dial:  
GROUP DIAL TELEPHONE NO. LIST is printed.  
282  
 
Registering Recipients Using Speed Dial Utility2 (macOS)  
About Speed Dial Utility2  
Speed Dial Utility2 is a utility for forwarding the telephone directory registered on the printer to a computer  
and registering/changing it on the computer. In addition, you can register the telephone directory edited on  
the computer to the printer. You can also save them on the computer as a backup.  
For safety reasons, it is recommended that you backup the registered data on the computer using Speed  
Dial Utility2.  
283  
 
Starting Up Speed Dial Utility2  
Important  
• Before starting up Speed Dial Utility2, make sure that the printer is connected to the computer correctly.  
• Do not plug in or unplug any cables while the printer is in operation, or when the computer is in sleep or  
standby mode.  
• If your printer is compatible with LAN connection, make sure that the printer is connected to the  
computer with LAN connection to use Speed Dial Utility2 via LAN connection.  
• The password entry screen may appear during startup or operation. If it appears, enter the  
administrator password, and then click OK. If you do not know the administrator password, contact the  
administrator of the printer.  
Follow the procedure below to start up Speed Dial Utility2.  
1. Select Applications on Go menu of Finder.  
2. Double-click Canon Utilities folder.  
3. Double-click Speed Dial Utility2 folder.  
4. Double-click Speed Dial Utility2.  
Speed Dial Utility2 starts up.  
Note  
• You can also start up Speed Dial Utility2 from Quick Utility Toolbox.  
284  
 
Speed Dial Utility2 Dialog  
The following items are on the Speed Dial Utility2 dialog.  
1. Printer Name:  
Selects the printer for editing the telephone directory using Speed Dial Utility2.  
Behind printer name, printer's MAC address is displayed.  
Note  
• For checking printer's MAC address, refer to "Checking Network Information" for your model from  
Home of the Online Manual.  
• For printer that supports both wireless LAN connection and wired LAN connection, MAC address  
of wired LAN connection is displayed regardless of the connection method.  
2. Display Printer Settings  
Loads the telephone directory registered on the printer that selected for Printer Name: into Speed Dial  
Utility2.  
3. Setting Item List:  
Selects a setting item for editing. Choose one item from TEL Number Registration, User Information  
Setting, and Rejected Number Setting.  
4. Registered information list  
285  
 
Displays the registered information selected for Setting Item List:.  
Note  
• By clicking on the item name, you can sort the display order.  
5. Edit.../Select All/Delete  
Edits the item that selected for Setting Item List:, or deletes the item, or selects all the items.  
When multiple items on the registered information list are selected, you cannot use the Edit... button.  
6. Load from PC...  
Displays the telephone directory saved on the computer.  
7. Instructions  
Displays this guide.  
8. Exit  
Quits Speed Dial Utility2. Information registered or edited using Speed Dial Utility2 is neither saved on  
the computer nor registered on the printer.  
9. Save to PC...  
Saves the telephone directory edited using Speed Dial Utility2 on the computer.  
10. Register to Printer  
Registers the telephone directory edited using Speed Dial Utility2 to the printer.  
286  
Saving Registered Telephone Directory on Printer to Your  
Computer  
Follow the procedure below to save the telephone directory (includes recipients' name, recipients' fax/  
telephone number, group dial, user's name, user's fax/telephone number, and rejected numbers) that  
registered on the printer to the computer.  
2. Select a printer from Printer Name: list box, and then click Display Printer Settings.  
3. Click Save to PC....  
4. Enter file name on displayed screen, and then click Save.  
Note  
• The data of the telephone directory (RSD file, *.rsd) can be imported to other printer.  
287  
 
Registering a Fax/telephone Number Using Speed Dial Utility2  
Follow the procedure below to register fax/telephone numbers.  
Note  
Before you register fax/telephone numbers using Speed Dial Utility2, make sure that no fax operations  
are in progress.  
2. Select a printer from Printer Name: list box, and then click Display Printer Settings.  
3. Click TEL Number Registration from Setting Item List:.  
The list of registered fax/telephone numbers is displayed.  
4. Select an unoccupied code from list, and then click Edit....  
The Individual or Group Selection dialog is displayed.  
5. Click Register individual TEL number or Register group dial, and then click Next....  
• If Register individual TEL number is selected:  
1. Enter name.  
2. Enter fax/telephone number.  
• If Register group dial is selected:  
1. Enter group name.  
2. Select a code you want to add to group dial, and then click Add >>.  
288  
 
Note  
• You can only add the numbers that have already been registered.  
6. Click OK.  
To continue registering fax/telephone numbers or a group dial, repeat steps 4 to 6.  
• To save the registered information on the computer.  
1. Click Save to PC....  
2. Enter file name on displayed screen, and then click Save.  
• To register the registered information to the printer:  
1. Click Register to Printer.  
2. When message appears, check it and click OK.  
The information is registered to the printer.  
289  
Changing a Fax/telephone Number Using Speed Dial Utility2  
Follow the procedure below to change fax/telephone numbers.  
Note  
• Before you change fax/telephone numbers using Speed Dial Utility2, make sure that no fax operations  
are in progress.  
2. Select a printer from Printer Name: list box, and then click Display Printer Settings.  
3. Click TEL Number Registration from Setting Item List:.  
The list of registered fax/telephone numbers is displayed.  
4. Select a code to change from list, and then click Edit....  
• If an individual fax/telephone number is selected:  
1. Enter a new name.  
2. Enter a new fax/telephone number.  
• If a group dial is selected:  
1. Enter a new group name.  
2. Add or delete a member to/from group dial.  
To add a member:  
Select a code to add to group dial, and then click Add >>.  
290  
 
To delete a member:  
Select a code to delete from group dial, and then click << Delete.  
5. Click OK.  
To continue changing fax/telephone numbers or group dials, repeat steps 4 and 5.  
• To save the edited information on the computer.  
1. Click Save to PC....  
2. Enter file name on displayed screen, and then click Save.  
• To register the edited information to the printer:  
1. Click Register to Printer.  
2. When message appears, check it and click OK.  
The information is registered to the printer.  
291  
Deleting a Fax/telephone Number Using Speed Dial Utility2  
Follow the procedure below to delete fax/telephone numbers.  
Note  
• Before you delete fax/telephone numbers using Speed Dial Utility2, make sure that no fax operations  
are in progress.  
2. Select a printer from Printer Name: list box, and then click Display Printer Settings.  
3. Click TEL Number Registration from Setting Item List:.  
The list of registered fax/telephone numbers is displayed.  
4. Select a code to delete from list, and then click Delete.  
Note  
• To delete all fax/telephone numbers on the list, click Select All, and then Delete.  
5. When confirmation screen appears, click OK.  
The selected fax/telephone number is deleted.  
To continue deleting fax/telephone numbers, repeat steps 4 and 5.  
• To save the edited information on the computer.  
1. Click Save to PC....  
2. Enter file name on the displayed screen, and then click Save.  
• To register the edited information to the printer:  
1. Click Register to Printer.  
2. When message appears, check it and click OK.  
The information is registered to the printer.  
292  
 
Changing Sender Information Using Speed Dial Utility2  
Follow the procedure below to change the user's name or fax/telephone number.  
2. Select a printer from Printer Name: list box, and then click Display Printer Settings.  
3. Click User Information Setting from Setting Item List:.  
The user's information is displayed.  
4. Select an item to change, and then click Edit....  
The User Information dialog is displayed.  
5. Enter new user's name on User Name and new fax/telephone number in TEL Number,  
and then click OK.  
• To save the edited information on the computer:  
1. Click Save to PC....  
2. Enter file name on displayed screen, and then click Save.  
• To register the edited information to the printer:  
1. Click Register to Printer.  
2. When message appears, check it and click OK.  
The information is registered to the printer.  
293  
 
Registering/Changing Rejected Number Using Speed Dial  
Utility2  
Follow the procedure below to register, change, or delete rejected numbers.  
2. Select a printer from Printer Name: list box, and then click Display Printer Settings.  
3. Click Rejected Number Setting from Setting Item List:.  
The list of rejected numbers is displayed.  
• To register a rejected number:  
1. Select an unoccupied code from list, and then click Edit....  
2. Enter fax/telephone number in Rejected Number dialog, and then click OK.  
• To change a rejected number:  
1. Select a code to change from list, and then click Edit....  
2. Enter fax/telephone number in Rejected Number dialog, and then click OK.  
• To delete a rejected number:  
1. Select a code to delete from list, and then click Delete.  
The selected fax/telephone number is deleted.  
Note  
• To delete all fax/telephone numbers on the list, click Select All, and then Delete.  
294  
 
Registering Telephone Directory Has been Saved on Your  
Computer to Printer  
You can load the data of the telephone directory (RSD file, *.rsd) and register it to your printer.  
The data of the telephone directory (RSD file, *.rsd) that is exported from other printer can be loaded and  
registered to your printer.  
Note  
• In Speed Dial Utility2, the data of the telephone directory (RSD file, *.rsd) that is exported using Speed  
Dial Utility can be loaded.  
2. Select a printer from Printer Name: list box, and then click Display Printer Settings.  
3. Click Load from PC....  
4. Select a data of telephone directory (RSD file, *.rsd) to register to your printer.  
5. Click Open on dialog.  
The selected telephone directory is displayed.  
Note  
• If you select the data of the telephone directory (RSD file, *.rsd) that is exported from other printer,  
the confirmation message appears. Click OK.  
6. Click Register to Printer.  
The telephone directory that has been saved on the computer is registered to your printer.  
295  
 
Sending Faxes by Entering Fax/Telephone Number  
This section describes dialing and sending faxes directly by entering the fax/telephone numbers.  
Important  
• It may be possible that faxes will reach unintended recipients due to the misdialing or incorrect  
registration of fax/telephone numbers. When you send important documents, we recommend that you  
send them after speaking on the telephone.  
Sending Fax after Speaking on Telephone  
2. Press the FAX button.  
The Fax standby screen is displayed.  
Important  
• When sending a double-sided document, load the document on the platen. Double-sided  
documents cannot be automatically scanned and sent from the ADF.  
Note  
• For details on the types, conditions of document, and how to load the document:  
4. Adjust the scan contrast and resolution as necessary.  
5. Use the Numeric buttons to dial the recipient's fax/telephone number.  
Use the following buttons to dial the recipient's fax/telephone number.  
Numeric buttons:  
Enters the number.  
button:  
Enters a space.  
button:  
Deletes the last character you entered.  
297  
 
button:  
By pressing this button once, "#" is entered. By pressing this button one more time, "P" is entered.  
6. Press the Color button for color transmission, or the Black button for black & white  
transmission.  
The printer starts scanning the document.  
Important  
• Color transmission is available only when the recipient's fax device supports color faxing.  
• Do not open the document cover until scanning is completed.  
7. Start sending.  
If you load the document in the ADF:  
The printer scans the document automatically and starts sending the fax.  
Note  
• To cancel a fax transmission, press the Stop button. To cancel a fax transmission while it is in  
progress, press the Stop button, then follow the instructions on the LCD.  
• If documents remain in the ADF after the Stop button is pressed while scanning is in progress,  
Document in ADF [OK]Eject the document is displayed on the LCD. By pressing the OK  
button, the remaining documents are automatically ejected.  
If you load the document on the platen:  
After scanning the document, the confirmation screen asking you if you load the next document is  
displayed.  
To send the scanned document, press the OK button to start sending it.  
To send two or more pages, follow the message to load the next page, and press the Color or  
Black button. After scanning all pages, press the OK button to start sending.  
Note  
• To cancel sending the fax, press the Stop button.  
Note  
• When your printer is connected to a PBX (Private Branch Exchange) system, refer to the operating  
instructions of the system for details on dialing the recipient's fax/telephone number.  
• In case the printer was not able to send a fax, such as when the recipient's line was busy, it has the  
function to automatically redial the number after a specified interval. Automatic redialing is enabled by  
default.  
• Unsent documents, such as those pending redial, are stored in the printer's memory. They are not  
stored in the case of a sending error.  
298  
• Do not unplug the power cord until all documents are sent. If you unplug the power cord, all unsent  
documents stored in the printer's memory are lost.  
299  
Resending Faxes (Redialing Busy Number)  
There are two methods of redialing: Automatic redialing and Manual redialing.  
• Automatic Redialing  
If you send a document and the recipient's line is busy, the printer will redial the number after a specified  
interval.  
• Manual Redialing  
You can redial to the recipients dialed using the Numeric buttons.  
Important  
• It may be possible that faxes will reach unintended recipients due to the misdialing or incorrect  
registration of fax/telephone numbers. When you send important documents, we recommend that you  
send them after speaking on the telephone.  
Sending Fax after Speaking on Telephone  
Note  
• Automatic redialing is enabled by default.  
• For details on the basic sending operations:  
Automatic Redialing  
You can enable or disable automatic redialing. If you enable automatic redialing, you can specify the  
maximum number of redial attempts and the length of time the printer waits between redial attempts.  
Enable and specify the automatic redialing setting on Auto redial in Adv. FAX settings under Fax  
settings.  
Important  
• While automatic redialing, the unsent fax is stored in the printer's memory temporarily until the  
sending fax is complete. If a power failure occurs or you unplug the power cord before automatic  
redialing is complete, all faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted and not sent.  
Note  
• To stop automatic redialing, wait until the printer starts redialing, then press the Stop button.  
• To cancel automatic redialing, delete the unsent fax from the printer's memory while the printer is on-  
standby for a redial operation. For details, see Deleting Document in Printer's Memory.  
300  
   
Manual Redialing  
Follow the procedure below for manual redialing.  
2. Press the FAX button.  
The Fax standby screen is displayed.  
4. Adjust the scan contrast and resolution as necessary.  
5. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.  
The FAX menu screen is displayed.  
6. Select Redial, then press the OK button.  
7. Select the recipient's number to redial, then press the OK button.  
8. Press the Color button for color transmission, or the Black button for black & white  
transmission.  
Important  
• Color transmission is available only when the recipient's fax device supports color faxing.  
Note  
• For manual redialing, the printer memorizes up to 10 recent recipients dialed by entering the fax/  
telephone numbers. Note that the printer does not memorize any recipients dialed using the redial  
function or selecting from the directory.  
• To cancel manual redialing, press the Stop button. To cancel a fax transmission while it is in  
progress, press the Stop button, then follow the instructions on the LCD.  
• If documents remain in the ADF after the Stop button is pressed while scanning is in progress,  
Document in ADF [OK]Eject the document is displayed on the LCD. By pressing the OK button,  
the remaining documents are automatically ejected.  
301  
 
Setting Items for Sending Faxes  
If you select FAX TX settings after pressing the Menu/Wireless connect button on the Fax standby  
screen, you can specify the settings of the scan contrast and the scan resolution.  
Adjust the scan contrast and resolution following the procedure below.  
1. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button on the Fax standby screen.  
The FAX menu screen is displayed.  
2. Select FAX TX settings, then press the OK button.  
3. Select Scan contrast, then press the OK button.  
4. Select the scan contrast, then press the OK button.  
The  
button decreases the scan contrast, and the  
button increases the scan contrast.  
5. Select Scan resolution, then press the OK button.  
6. Select the scan resolution.  
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
Standard  
Suitable for text-only documents.  
Fine  
Suitable for fine-print documents.  
Extra fine  
Suitable for detailed illustration or fine-print quality documents.  
If the recipient's fax device is not compatible with Extra fine (300 x 300 dpi), the fax will be sent in  
the Standard or Fine resolution.  
Photo  
Suitable for photographs.  
302  
 
Note  
• When sending a color fax, documents are always scanned in the same resolution (200 x 200 dpi).  
The image quality (compression rate) is determined by which scan resolution is selected, except  
that Extra fine and Photo provide the same image quality.  
7. Press the OK button.  
The LCD returns to the Fax standby screen.  
303  
Sending Faxes Using AirPrint  
You can send faxes from a printer using AirPrint.  
To send faxes, add your printer to your computer.  
Checking Environment  
First, check your environment.  
AirPrint operation environment  
A computer running Mac OS.  
Note  
• For supported operating system versions, click Home to return to the top page of the Online  
Manual for your model and search for "Specifications."  
Requirement  
The computer and your printer must be connected correctly.  
Adding Printer to Computer  
1. Open System Preferences and select Printers & Scanners (Print & Scan).  
2. Click + to display printer list.  
3. Select printer model name with Bonjour Multifunction displayed.  
Note  
• If the printer does not appear, check the following.  
• The printer is turned on.  
• The firewall function of the security software is off.  
• The printer is connected to the access point or directly connected to the computer.  
• If using the printer with USB connection, select USB Multifunction.  
4. Select Secure AirPrint or AirPrint from Use.  
5. Click Add.  
Sending Fax  
Note  
• Only black and white transmission is supported.  
305  
 
1. Make sure printer is on.  
2. In application, open document to fax.  
3. Open Print dialog.  
To open the Print dialog, you typically select Print... from the File menu of your application software.  
4. Select Canon XXX series - Fax (where "XXX" is the model name) from Printer list.  
5. Specify fax paper settings as needed.  
306  
6. Enter fax/telephone numbers in To.  
307  
If you specify a dialing prefix, enter the code in Dialing Prefix and specify the cover page settings as  
needed.  
7. Click Fax.  
The number is dialed automatically and the fax is sent.  
Note  
• To cancel sending the fax, press the printer's Stop button.  
Automatic Redialing  
If the fax could not be sent (for example, when the recipient was busy), the number is redialed  
automatically according to the automatic redialing setting of the printer.  
You can enable or disable automatic redialing. If you enable automatic redialing, you can specify the  
maximum number of redial attempts and the length of time the printer waits between redial attempts.  
Note  
• To cancel automatic redialing, wait until redialing starts, and then press the printer's Stop button.  
• For more details, click Home to return to the top page of the Online Manual for your model and  
search for "FAX settings."  
308  
General Notes (Fax Transmission Using AirPrint)  
Sending faxes is subject to the following restrictions.  
• Enter the characters in To and Dialing Prefix so that the total number of characters is within 40  
characters.  
• You can use the following characters for To:  
Character  
0 - 9 * #  
+ space  
Explanation  
For use in telephone and fax numbers.  
To make the number easier to read. You cannot insert a space at the front of a number.  
• You can use the following characters for Dialing Prefix:  
Character  
Explanation  
For use in telephone and fax numbers.  
0 - 9 * #  
p
To place a pause between numbers.  
T
Numbers after the T will be sent as a tone signal.  
+ space  
To make the number easier to read. You cannot insert a space at the front of a number.  
309  
 
Receiving Faxes  
This section describes the preparation necessary for receiving a fax and how to receive a fax.  
Preparing for Receiving a Fax  
Prepare for receiving a fax according to the following procedure.  
2. Press the FAX button.  
The Fax standby screen is displayed.  
3. Make sure of the receive mode setting.  
Make sure of the receive mode setting displayed on the Fax standby screen.  
Note  
• For details on how to change the receive mode:  
Load the sheets of plain paper.  
5. Specify the paper settings as necessary.  
This completes the preparation for receiving fax.  
When a fax is received, it is printed on the loaded paper automatically.  
Receiving a Fax  
Depending on the selected receive mode, the receive operation varies.  
Note  
• For details on the receive mode:  
• You can specify the advanced settings of each receive mode.  
For details on the advanced settings of the receive mode:  
311  
 
• If the printer was not able to print a received fax, the printer stores the unprinted fax in its memory  
(Substitute Reception).  
When TEL priority mode is selected:  
When the call is a fax:  
The telephone will ring when a call incomes.  
Pick up the handset. If you hear the fax tone, wait for at least 5 seconds after it stops, then hang up  
the handset.  
The printer will receive the fax.  
Note  
• If the printer will not switch to fax reception, press the FAX button, then the Color or Black  
button to receive the fax.  
• To receive a fax without picking up the handset, set Manual/auto switch of the advanced  
setting to ON. RX start time allows you to specify the number of seconds until the printer  
switches to fax reception.  
• If you have subscribed to Duplex Ringing service in Hong Kong, the telephone will ring a  
specified number of times when there is an incoming call with a fax distinctive ring pattern.  
Then, the printer will switch to fax reception automatically without the handset being picked up.  
The number of times to ring the telephone until switching to fax reception can be changed.  
• Set the printer to enable you to initiate fax reception from a connected telephone (remote  
reception).  
Remote Reception  
When the answering machine is connected to the printer:  
• If the answering machine is set to the answering mode, set User-friendly RX of the  
advanced setting to ON. If the call is a fax, the printer will receive the fax automatically.  
312  
• If the answering mode is turned off on the answering machine, pick up the handset. If you  
hear the fax tone, wait for at least 5 seconds after it stops, then hang up the handset.  
• If Manual/auto switch of the advanced setting is set to ON, set RX start time to longer  
than the time before the answering machine starts playing the answering message. After  
making this setting, we recommend that you call the answering machine using a mobile  
phone, etc. to confirm that messages are recorded successfully in the answering machine.  
• Set your answering machine to answering mode and adjust it as follows:  
• The entire message should be no longer than 15 seconds.  
• In the message, tell your callers how to send a fax.  
When the call is a voice call:  
The telephone will ring when a call incomes.  
Pick up the handset, and talk on the telephone.  
Note  
• If the printer unexpectedly switches to fax reception during telephone calls, set User-friendly  
RX of the advanced setting to OFF.  
• If Manual/auto switch of the advanced setting is set to ON, you must answer an incoming call  
by picking up the handset within the time specified in RX start time. Otherwise the printer will  
switch to fax reception.  
When Fax only mode is selected:  
When the call is a fax:  
The printer will receive the fax automatically.  
Note  
• If a telephone is connected to the printer, the telephone will ring when a call incomes.  
313  
• You can change the number of times to ring the telephone with Incoming ring of the advanced  
setting.  
When DRPD or Network switch is selected:  
When the call is a fax:  
The telephone will ring when a call incomes.  
The printer will receive the fax automatically when the fax ring pattern is detected.  
Note  
• You can change the number of times to ring the telephone.  
When the call is a voice call:  
The telephone will ring when a call incomes.  
When the printer does not detect the fax ring pattern, the telephone will continue ringing.  
Pick up the handset, and talk on the telephone.  
Note  
• To use this feature, you need to subscribe to a compatible service provided by your telephone  
company.  
For DRPD  
You need to select the appropriate ring pattern on the printer.  
314  
For Network switch  
The name of this service varies depending on the country or region of purchase. This setting  
may not be also available depending on the country or region of purchase.  
315  
Changing Paper Settings  
This printer prints received faxes to paper loaded in the printer beforehand. You can use the operation panel  
to change the paper settings for printing faxes. Make sure that the settings are appropriate for the loaded  
paper.  
Important  
• If the size of loaded paper is different from that specified in the paper size setting, Check page size  
Press [OK] are displayed on the LCD. In this case, load the same size of paper as that specified in the  
paper size setting, then press the OK button.  
You can also press the Stop button to close the message and print the stored documents in the  
printer's memory later.  
• If no paper is loaded, or paper has run out while printing is in progress, the error message for no paper  
is displayed on the LCD. In this case, load paper and press the OK button.  
You can also press the Stop button to close the message and print the stored documents in the  
printer's memory later.  
Note  
• If the sender sends a document that is larger than Letter-size or Legal-size, such as 11 x 17 inches, the  
sender's printer may send the fax automatically reduced in size or divided, or send only a part of the  
original.  
2. Press the FAX button.  
The Fax standby screen is displayed.  
3. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.  
The FAX menu screen is displayed.  
4. Select FAX paper settings, then press the OK button.  
5. Select a setting item, then press the OK button.  
6. Specify the settings.  
Use the  
button to adjust each setting item, then press the OK button. The next setting item is  
displayed.  
The LCD returns to the Fax standby screen when all the settings are complete or when pressing the  
FAX button.  
316  
 
Note  
• The  
(asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.  
Page size  
Select the page size from A4, Letter, or Legal.  
Note  
• Some of page sizes are not available depending on the country or region of purchase.  
Media type  
The paper type is set to Plain paper.  
2-sided  
Select whether to perform two-sided printing when printing faxes, reports, or lists.  
317  
Memory Reception  
If the printer was not able to print the received fax, the received fax is stored in the printer's memory. The  
FAX Memory lamp is lit and Received in memory is displayed at the Fax standby screen.  
Important  
• If you unplug the power cord, all faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted. The next time you  
turn the printer on, press the OK button after a confirmation screen is displayed. The list of the faxes  
deleted from the printer's memory (MEMORY CLEAR REPORT) will be printed.  
If the printer receives a fax under one of the following conditions, the received fax will be automatically  
stored in the printer's memory.  
The printer is set to store received faxes in its memory:  
When Do not print is selected for Received documents in Auto print settings under FAX settings,  
the received faxes are stored in the printer's memory.  
You can print the faxes stored in the printer's memory from Memory reference in the FAX menu  
screen.  
Note  
• To print the received faxes automatically, select Print for Received documents in Auto print  
settings under FAX settings.  
An error has occurred on the printer:  
If you select Print for Received documents in Auto print settings under FAX settings, a received fax  
will be printed automatically. However, if any of the following errors occurs, the received fax will not be  
printed. It will instead be stored in the printer's memory.  
When the error is resolved, the fax stored in the printer's memory is printed automatically.  
◦ The amount of remaining ink is insufficient to print a fax:  
Replace the FINE cartridge.  
Note  
• You can set the printer to forcibly print a received fax even if the ink has run out.  
Set Print when no ink in Auto print settings under FAX settings to Print.  
However, part or all of the fax may not be printed since the ink has run out.  
Also, the contents of the fax will not be stored in the printer's memory.  
If the ink has already run out, we recommend that Do not print be selected for Received  
documents in Auto print settings under FAX settings to store the received fax in the printer's  
memory. After you replace the FINE cartridge and select Print for Received documents in  
Auto print settings, the fax stored in the printer's memory will be printed automatically.  
318  
 
◦ Paper has run out:  
Load the paper and press the OK button.  
◦ A different size of paper from that specified by Page size in FAX paper settings is loaded:  
Load the same size of paper as that specified by Page size in FAX paper settings, and then press  
the OK button.  
You pressed the Stop button to cancel printing of a fax:  
To resume printing of the fax, display the Fax standby screen by pressing the FAX button again.  
Note  
• The printer can store up to max. 50 pages* (max. 20 documents) of faxes in the printer's memory.  
* When using ITU-T No.1 chart (Standard mode)  
• If the printer's memory becomes full during memory reception, only pages which already have been  
received are stored in the memory. Print the received faxes stored in the printer's memory, and then  
delete them from the printer's memory and have the sender resend the faxes.  
319  
Other Useful Fax Functions  
320  
 
Document Stored in Printer's Memory  
If the sending faxes is not complete or the printer was not able to print the received faxes, these faxes are  
stored in the printer's memory.  
If an error occurred during a fax transmission, the document is not stored in the printer's memory.  
In the following cases, the printer is not able to print the received fax and will automatically store the fax in  
its memory.  
• The amount of remaining ink is insufficient to print a fax.  
• Paper has run out.  
• A different size of paper from that specified by Page size in FAX paper settings is loaded.  
Do not print is selected for Received documents in Auto print settings under FAX settings.  
• You pressed the Stop button to cancel printing of a received fax.  
Important  
• If you unplug the power cord of the printer, all faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.  
For details on how to unplug the power cord, refer to Unplugging the Printer.  
You can print or delete the faxes stored in the printer's memory.  
• To print a document in the printer's memory:  
• To delete a document in the printer's memory:  
Note  
• When confirming, printing, or deleting a document stored in the printer's memory, you specify it by its  
transaction number. If you do not know the transaction number for your target document, print the list of  
documents (MEMORY LIST) first.  
For details on how to print MEMORY LIST, see Printing Document in Printer's Memory.  
321  
 
Printing Document in Printer's Memory  
You can print a specified document in the printer's memory or print all the received documents in its memory  
at a time.  
When printing a specified document, you specify it by its transaction number. If you do not know the  
transaction number for your target document, print the list of documents (MEMORY LIST) first.  
3. Press the FAX button.  
The Fax standby screen is displayed.  
4. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.  
The FAX menu screen is displayed.  
5. Select Memory reference, then press the OK button.  
Note  
• If no document is stored in the printer's memory, No documents in memory is displayed on the  
LCD.  
6. Select a print menu, then press the OK button.  
Print memory list  
You can print a list of the documents in the printer's memory (MEMORY LIST).  
MEMORY LIST shows the transaction number of the unsent or unprinted fax (TX/RX NO.),  
transaction mode, recipient's number, and the date and time of the transaction.  
A transaction number from "0001" to "4999" on MEMORY LIST indicates a document being sent. A  
transaction number from "5001" to "9999" on MEMORY LIST indicates a document being received.  
Print specified doc.  
You can specify the document and print it.  
If you select this menu, the document selection screen is displayed.  
Note  
• A transaction number from "0001" to "4999" indicates a document being sent. A transaction  
number from "5001" to "9999" indicates a document being received.  
• Each mark before the transaction number indicates the following:  
No mark: Indicates a black and white document.  
322  
 
: Indicates a color document.  
: Indicates the document during transmission.  
: Indicates the document sent with sequential broadcasting.  
• By pressing the  
button or the Tone button, the transaction number displayed on the LCD  
is switched to transaction time or fax/telephone number.  
Specify the document and print it following the procedure below.  
1. Select the transaction number (TX/RX no.) of the document you want to print, then press the  
OK button.  
2. Select whether to print only the first page of the document, then press the OK button.  
• If you select Yes:  
Only the first page of the document will be printed.  
The document is still stored in the printer's memory.  
• If you select No:  
All pages of the document will be printed.  
The screen to confirm whether to delete the printed document in the printer's memory is  
displayed.  
If you select Yes and press the OK button, the printed document in the printer's memory is  
deleted.  
Note  
• If there is not the specified document in the printer's memory, No document is displayed,  
and the printer returns to the previous screen.  
• To return to the Fax standby screen, press the Stop button.  
Print all RX docs  
If you select this menu, the confirmation screen is displayed.  
You can print all the received documents in the printer's memory.  
If you select Yes and press the OK button, all the documents in the printer's memory will be printed.  
Each time a document is printed, the screen to confirm whether to delete the printed document in  
the printer's memory is displayed.  
If you select Yes and press the OK button, the printed document in the printer's memory is deleted.  
323  
Deleting Document in Printer's Memory  
You can delete a specified document in the printer's memory or delete all the documents in its memory at a  
time.  
Note  
• When deleting a specified document, you specify it by its transaction number (TX/RX no.). If you do not  
know the transaction number for your target document, print the list of documents (MEMORY LIST)  
first.  
2. Press the FAX button.  
The Fax standby screen is displayed.  
3. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.  
The FAX menu screen is displayed.  
4. Select Memory reference, then press the OK button.  
Note  
• If no document is stored in the printer's memory, No documents in memory is displayed on the  
LCD.  
5. Select a delete menu, then press the OK button.  
Del. specified doc.  
You can specify the document and delete it.  
If you select this menu, the document selection screen is displayed.  
Note  
• A transaction number from "0001" to "4999" indicates a document being sent. A transaction  
number from "5001" to "9999" indicates a document being received.  
• Each mark before the transaction number indicates the following:  
No mark: Indicates a black and white document.  
: Indicates a color document.  
: Indicates the document during transmission.  
: Indicates the document sent with sequential broadcasting.  
324  
 
• By pressing the  
button or the Tone button, the transaction number displayed on the LCD  
is switched to transaction time or fax/telephone number.  
Specify the document and delete it following the procedure below.  
1. Select the transaction number (TX/RX no.) of the document you want to delete, then press the  
OK button.  
The confirmation screen is displayed.  
2. Select Yes, then press the OK button.  
The specified document will be deleted from printer's memory.  
Note  
• If there is not the specified document in the printer's memory, No document is displayed,  
and the printer returns to the previous screen.  
• To return to the Fax standby screen, press the Stop button.  
Delete all docs  
If you select this menu, the confirmation screen is displayed.  
You can delete all the documents in the printer's memory.  
If you select Yes and press the OK button, all the documents in the printer's memory will be deleted.  
325  
Automatic Duplex Printing Problems  
Scanning Problems (Windows)  
Scan Results Are Unsatisfactory (Windows)  
Scan Results Are Unsatisfactory (macOS)  
Cannot Set Correctly (Network)  
Forgot Administrator Password of Printer  
Message Appears on Computer During Setup  
Cannot Set Correctly (Installation)  
Easy-WebPrint EX Does Not Start or Easy-WebPrint EX Menu Does Not Appear (Windows)  
Error or Message Appears  
A Message for Faxing Is Displayed on the LCD  
IJ Scan Utility Error Messages (Windows)  
IJ Scan Utility Lite Error Messages (macOS)  
ScanGear (Scanner Driver) Error Messages (Windows)  
Operation Problems  
Scanning Problems (Windows)  
If You Cannot Solve a Problem  
327  
Network Settings and Common Problems  
Here are frequently asked questions on network. Select a connection method you are using, or you want to  
use.  
Wireless LAN  
Wireless Direct  
Wireless LAN  
Cannot Find Printer  
Printer Is Not Found by Printer Find Screen of Setup  
Searching Printer by IP Address or Host Name During Setup  
Error Occurs During Wi-Fi Setup  
Cannot Print or Connect  
Cannot Access to Internet on Wi-Fi from Communication Device  
Connecting Printer and Wireless Router Using Easy wireless connect  
Cannot Connect Smartphone/Tablet to Wireless Router  
Error Occurs During Wi-Fi Setup  
Cannot Print or Connect  
LAN Setting Tips/Changing LAN Settings  
Forgot Administrator Password of Printer  
Checking Wireless Router SSID/Key  
Checking Wireless Router Network Name (SSID) for Smartphone/Tablet  
Privacy Separator/SSID Separator/Network Separation Function  
Checking Status Code  
328  
   
Printing/Scanning from Smartphone/Tablet  
Connecting Printer and Wireless Router Using Easy wireless connect  
Cannot Connect Smartphone/Tablet to Wireless Router  
Checking Wireless Router Network Name (SSID) for Smartphone/Tablet  
Setting Up Using Smartphone/Tablet  
Downloading Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY  
Problems while Using Printer  
Message Appears on Computer During Setup  
Printer Prints Slowly  
No Ink Level Appears in Printer Status Monitor (Windows)  
Packets Are Sent Constantly (Windows)  
Wireless Direct  
Cannot Print or Connect  
Cannot Access to Internet on Wi-Fi from Communication Device  
Cannot Print or Connect  
LAN Setting Tips/Changing LAN Settings  
Forgot Administrator Password of Printer  
Checking Status Code  
Printing/Scanning from Smartphone/Tablet  
Downloading Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY  
Problems while Using Printer  
Message Appears on Computer During Setup  
Printer Prints Slowly  
No Ink Level Appears in Printer Status Monitor (Windows)  
329  
 
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi  
Setup (Windows)-Checking Power Status  
Are printer and network device (router, etc.) turned on?  
Make sure the printer is turned on.  
Make sure network device (router, etc.) is turned on.  
If printer or network device is off:  
Turn on printer or network device.  
It may take a while for the printer and network device to become ready for use once they are turned on.  
Wait a while after turning on the printer or network device, and then click Redetect on the Check Printer  
Settings screen to redetect the printer.  
If the printer is found, follow the instructions on the screen to continue to set up network communication.  
If printer and network device are on:  
If the network devices are on, turn them off and on again.  
If above does not solve the problem:  
333  
 
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi  
Setup (Windows)-Checking PC Network Connection  
Can you view any web pages on your computer?  
Make sure the computer and network device (router, etc.) are configured and the computer is connected  
to the network.  
If you cannot view any web pages:  
Click Cancel on the Check Printer Settings screen to cancel to set up the network communication.  
After that, configure the computer and network device.  
For the procedures, refer to the instruction manuals supplied with the computer and network device, or  
contact their manufacturers.  
If you can view web pages after configuring the computer and network device, try to set up the network  
communication from the beginning.  
If above does not solve the problem:  
334  
 
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi  
Setup (Windows)-Checking Printer's Wi-Fi Settings  
Is printer set to allow wireless communication?  
Make sure the  
or  
icon is displayed on the LCD.  
If icon is not displayed:  
The printer is not set to allow wireless communication. Turn on wireless communication on the printer.  
If icon is displayed:  
335  
 
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi  
Setup (Windows)-Checking Wi-Fi Environment  
Is the printer connected to the wireless router?  
Use the icon on the LCD to make sure the printer is connected to the wireless router.  
If  
is displayed:  
• Check wireless router configuration.  
After checking the wireless router setting, make sure the printer is not placed far away from the  
wireless router.  
The printer can be up to 50 m (164 ft) from the wireless router indoors. Make sure the printer is close  
enough to the wireless router to be used.  
Place the printer and wireless router where there are no obstacles between them. Wireless  
communication between different rooms or floors is generally poor. Wireless communication can be  
impeded by building materials containing metal or concrete. If the printer cannot communicate with  
the computer over a Wi-Fi due to a wall, place the printer and the computer in the same room.  
In addition, if a device like a microwave oven that emits radio waves of the same frequency bandwidth  
as a wireless router is nearby, it may cause interference. Place the wireless router as far away from  
interference sources as possible.  
Note  
• Though an antenna is attached to most wireless routers, note that some of them have it inside.  
• Check wireless router setting.  
The printer and wireless router should be connected using 2.4 GHz bandwidth. Make sure the  
wireless router for the printer's destination is configured to use 2.4 GHz bandwidth.  
Important  
• Note that some wireless routers distinguish network names (SSIDs) by the last alphanumeric  
character according to their bandwidth (2.4 GHz or 5 GHz) or purpose (for computer or game  
machine).  
To check the network name (SSID) of the wireless router the printer is connected to, print the network  
settings.  
336  
 
For details, see the instruction manual supplied with the wireless router or contact the manufacturer.  
After taking measures above, click Redetect on the Check Printer Settings screen to redetect the  
printer.  
If the printer is found, follow the instructions on the screen to continue to set up network communication.  
If the printer cannot be detected, the printer is not connected to the wireless router. Connect the printer to  
the wireless router.  
After connecting the printer to the wireless router, set up the network communication from the beginning.  
If  
is displayed:  
337  
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi  
Setup (Windows)-Checking Printer's IP Address  
Is printer's IP address specified correctly?  
If printer's IP address is not specified correctly, the printer may not be found. Make sure whether printer's  
IP address is not used for another device.  
To check the printer's IP address, print out the network settings information.  
If the IP address is not specified correctly:  
See If an error screen appears: and specify the IP address.  
If the IP address is specified correctly:  
338  
 
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi  
Setup (Windows)-Checking Security Software Settings  
Disable block in firewall function temporarily.  
The firewall of your security software or operation system for computer may limit communication between  
the printer and your computer. Check the firewall setting of your security software or operation system or  
the message shown on your computer and disable block temporarily.  
If firewall interferes with setup:  
If message appears:  
If a message appears warning that Canon software is attempting to access the network, set the  
security software to allow access.  
After allowing the software to access, click Redetect on the Check Printer Settings screen to  
redetect the printer.  
If the printer is found, follow the instructions on the screen to continue to set up network  
communication.  
If no message appears:  
Cancel the setup, and then set the security software to allow Canon software to access the network.  
The file Setup.exe or Setup64.exe in the win > Driver > DrvSetup folder on the Setup CD-ROM  
After setting the security software, redo the network communication setup from the beginning.  
After setup is completed, enable firewall.  
Note  
• For more on firewall settings of your operating system or security software, see instruction manual or  
contact its manufacturer.  
If above does not solve the problem:  
339  
 
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi  
Setup (Windows)-Checking Wireless Router Settings  
Check wireless router settings.  
Check wireless router network connection settings, such as IP address filtering, MAC address filtering,  
encryption key, and DHCP function.  
Make sure the same radio channel is assigned to the printer and the wireless router.  
To check the settings of the wireless router, see the instruction manual supplied with the wireless router or  
contact the manufacturer.  
In addition, make sure the wireless router you are using is configured to use 2.4 GHz bandwidth.  
Important  
• Depending on the wireless router, note that different network name (SSID) is assigned for a  
bandwidth (2.4 GHz or 5 GHz) or its usage (for PC or game machine) using alphanumeric characters  
at the end of network name (SSID).  
After checking the wireless router settings, click Redetect on the Check Printer Settings screen to  
redetect the printer.  
If the printer is found, follow the instructions on the screen to continue to set up network communication.  
340  
 
Cannot Proceed beyond Printer Connection Screen  
If you cannot proceed beyond the Printer Connection screen, check the following.  
Check1  
Make sure USB cable is securely plugged in to printer and computer.  
Connect the printer and the computer using a USB cable as the illustration below. The USB port is located at the  
back of the printer.  
Important  
• Connect the "Type-B" terminal to the printer with the notched side facing UP. For details, refer to the  
instruction manual supplied with the USB cable.  
Check2  
Follow procedure below to connect printer and computer again.  
Important  
• For macOS, make sure the lock icon is on the lower left of the Printers & Scanners screen.  
If the icon (locked) is displayed, click the icon to unlock. (The administrator name and the password  
are necessary to unlock.)  
1. Unplug USB cable from printer and computer and connect it again.  
2. Make sure no printer operation is in progress and turn off.  
3. Turn on printer.  
Check3  
• For Windows:  
If you cannot resolve problem, follow procedure below to reinstall MP Drivers.  
1. Click Cancel.  
2. Click Back to Top on Setup Canceled screen.  
3. Click Exit on Start Setup screen and finish setup.  
341  
 
4. Turn off printer.  
5. Restart computer.  
6. Make sure you have no application software running.  
7. Perform setup on web page.  
Note  
• You can use the Setup CD-ROM to redo setup.  
• For macOS:  
1. Click Next.  
The screen telling you that installation has not been completed appears.  
2. Click No.  
The screen to select application software to install appears.  
3. Click Back to Top.  
4. Click Exit on Start Setup screen.  
5. Turn off printer.  
6. Restart computer.  
7. Make sure you have no application software running.  
8. Perform setup on web page.  
342  
Cannot Find Printer while Using Wi-Fi  
Check1  
Make sure printer is turned on.  
If not, make sure the printer is securely plugged in and press ON button to turn on.  
The ON lamp flashes while the printer is initializing. Wait until the ON lamp stops flashing and remains lit.  
Check2  
The  
Check the  
icon on LCD .  
icon appears when you switch a mode by pressing the SCAN button or Setup button.  
If the icon is not displayed, select Active for Enable/disab. Wi-Fi in Wi-Fi under LAN settings under Device  
settings from the setup menu.  
If the  
icon is displayed, see Check 3 or later checking items to make sure whether printer setup is  
complete or the settings of wireless router to connect are correct.  
Check3  
Make sure printer setup is complete on the computer.  
If it is not, perform setup.  
• For Windows:  
Perform setup using the Setup CD-ROM or from the web page.  
• For macOS:  
Perform setup from the web page.  
Note  
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status. Download it from the  
web page.  
For Windows  
For macOS  
Check4  
Make sure printer and wireless router network settings match.  
Make sure the network settings of the printer (e.g. network name (SSID) or network key (password), etc.) are  
identical with those of the wireless router.  
To check the settings of the wireless router, refer to the instruction manual provided with it or contact its  
manufacturer.  
Note  
• Use 2.4 GHz frequency band to connect to a wireless router. Match the network name (SSID) set for the  
printer with that for 2.4 GHz frequency band of the wireless router.  
To check the network name (SSID) set for the printer, print out the network setting information.  
343  
 
Note  
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.  
Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.  
Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.  
• For Windows:  
Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
• For macOS:  
Check5  
Make sure the printer is not placed too far away from the wireless router.  
If the distance between the printer and wireless router is too far, wireless communication becomes poor. Place  
the printer and wireless router close to each other.  
Note  
• Though an antenna is attached to most wireless routers, note that some of them have it inside.  
Check6  
Make sure wireless signal is strong. Monitor signal strength and move printer  
and wireless router as necessary.  
Place the printer and wireless router where there are no obstacles between them. Wireless communication  
between different rooms or floors is generally poor. Wireless communication can be impeded by building  
materials containing metal or concrete. If the printer cannot communicate with the computer over a Wi-Fi due to  
a wall, place the printer and the computer in the same room.  
In addition, if a device like a microwave oven that emits radio waves of the same frequency bandwidth as a  
wireless router is nearby, it may cause interference. Place the wireless router as far away from interference  
sources as possible.  
Check the signal strength on the LCD.  
Note  
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.  
Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.  
Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.  
• For Windows:  
Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
• For macOS:  
344  
Check7  
Make sure the computer is connected to the wireless router.  
For more on how to check the computer settings or connection status, see your computer instruction manual or  
contact its manufacturer.  
Note  
• If you use a smartphone or tablet, make sure the Wi-Fi is enabled on the device.  
Check8  
Make sure Enable bidirectional support is selected in the Ports sheet of the  
properties dialog box of the printer driver. (Windows)  
If not, select it to enable bidirectional support.  
Check9  
Make sure security software's firewall is off.  
If your security software's firewall is on, a message may appear warning you that Canon software is attempting  
to access the network. If this warning message appears, set security software to always allow access.  
If you are using any programs that switch between network environments, check their settings. Some programs  
use a firewall by default.  
Check10  
If printer is connected to an AirPort Base Station via LAN, make sure you use  
alphanumeric characters for network name (SSID). (macOS)  
If the problem is not resolved, redo setup.  
• For Windows:  
Perform setup using the Setup CD-ROM or from the web page.  
• For macOS:  
Perform setup from the web page.  
345  
Printer Suddenly Stopped Working for Some Reason  
Cannot Connect to a Printer after Network Configuration Changes  
It may take a while for the computer to obtain an IP address, or you may need to restart your computer.  
Make sure the computer has obtained a valid IP address, and try again to find the printer.  
Cannot Connect to a Printer via Wireless LAN (Wi-Fi)  
Check1  
Check the power status of printer, network devices (e.g. wireless router), and  
smartphone/tablet.  
• Turn on the printer or devices.  
• If the power is already turned on, cycle the power switch.  
• It may be necessary to resolve wireless router problems (e.g. update interval of a key, problems of DHCP  
update interval, energy saving mode, etc.) or to update the wireless router firmware.  
For details, contact the manufacturer of your wireless router.  
Check2  
Can you view any web pages on your computer?  
Make sure your computer is connected to the wireless router properly.  
For more on checking computer settings or connection status, see the instruction manual supplied with the  
computer or contact the manufacturer.  
Check3  
Is the printer connected to the wireless router?  
Use the icon on the LCD to check the connection status between the printer and wireless router. If the  
icon is not displayed, Wi-Fi is disabled. Turn on wireless communication on the printer.  
Check4  
Make sure the printer and wireless router network settings match.  
Make sure the network settings of the printer (e.g. network name (SSID) or network key (password), etc.) are  
identical with those of the wireless router.  
To check the settings of the wireless router, refer to the instruction manual provided with it or contact its  
manufacturer.  
347  
     
Note  
• Use 2.4 GHz frequency band to connect to a wireless router. Match the network name (SSID) set for the  
printer with that for 2.4 GHz frequency band of the wireless router.  
To check the current network settings of the printer, print out the network setting information.  
Note  
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.  
Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.  
Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.  
• For Windows:  
Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
• For macOS:  
Check5  
Make sure the printer is not placed too far away from the wireless router.  
If the distance between the printer and wireless router is too far, wireless communication becomes poor. Place  
the printer and wireless router close to each other.  
Note  
• Though an antenna is attached to most wireless routers, note that some of them have it inside.  
Check6  
Make sure wireless signal is strong. Monitor signal status and move printer  
and wireless router as necessary.  
Place the printer and wireless router where there are no obstacles between them. Wireless communication  
between different rooms or floors is generally poor. Wireless communication can be impeded by building  
materials containing metal or concrete. If the printer cannot communicate with the computer over a Wi-Fi due  
to a wall, place the printer and the computer in the same room.  
In addition, if a device like a microwave oven that emits radio waves of the same frequency bandwidth as a  
wireless router is nearby, it may cause interference. Place the wireless router as far away from interference  
sources as possible.  
Check the signal strength on the LCD.  
Note  
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.  
Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.  
Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.  
• For Windows:  
348  
Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
• For macOS:  
Check7  
Make sure of the Wi-Fi channel numbers used for your computer.  
You need to have the same Wi-Fi channel number that you are using for the wireless router as your computer.  
It is normally set in the way that you can use all the Wi-Fi channels. However, when the channels that you are  
using are restricted, the Wi-Fi channels do not match.  
See the instruction manual provided with your computer and check the Wi-Fi channel number available for  
your computer.  
Check8  
Make sure channel set on wireless router is a usable channel as confirmed in  
Check 7.  
If it is not, change the channel set on the wireless router.  
Check9  
Make sure security software's firewall is off.  
If your security software's firewall is on, a message may appear warning you that Canon software is attempting  
to access the network. If this warning message appears, set security software to always allow access.  
If you are using any programs that switch between network environments, check their settings. Some  
programs use a firewall by default.  
Check10  
If printer is connected to an AirPort Base Station via LAN, make sure you  
use alphanumeric characters for network name (SSID). (macOS)  
If the problem is not resolved, redo setup.  
• For Windows:  
Perform setup using the Setup CD-ROM or from the web page.  
• For macOS:  
Perform setup from the web page.  
Positioning:  
Make sure there are no obstacles between the printer and the wireless router.  
Cannot Connect to a Printer through Wireless Direct  
Check1  
Check the power status of printer and other devices (smartphone or tablet).  
Turn on the printer or devices.  
If the power is already turned on, cycle the power switch.  
349  
 
Check2  
Select LAN settings > Wireless Direct > Switch WL Direct in this order and select Yes.  
Check3  
Check printer settings.  
Check the settings of your device (smartphone/tablet).  
Make sure Wi-Fi is enabled on your device.  
For details, refer to your device's instruction manual.  
Check4  
Make sure printer is selected as connection for device (e.g. smartphone or  
tablet).  
Select the network name (SSID) for Wireless Direct specified for the printer as the connection destination for  
devices.  
Check the destination on your device.  
For details, refer to your device's instruction manual or visit the manufacturer's website.  
To check the network name (SSID) for Wireless Direct specified for the printer, print out the network setting  
information of the printer.  
Check5  
Have you entered the proper password specified for the Wireless Direct?  
To check the password specified for the printer, print out the network setting information of the printer.  
Check6  
Make sure the printer is not placed too far away from the device.  
If the distance between the printer and device is too far, wireless communication becomes poor. Place the  
printer and device close to each other.  
Check7  
Make sure 5 devices are already connected.  
Wireless Direct does not allow more than 5 devices to be connected.  
Cannot Print/Scan/Fax through Network  
Check1  
Make sure the computer is connected to the wireless router.  
For more on how to check the computer settings or connection status, see your computer instruction manual  
or contact its manufacturer.  
Check2  
Install the MP Drivers using the Setup CD-ROM or install them from the Canon website.  
If MP Drivers are not installed, install them. (Windows)  
Check3  
Make sure wireless router does not restrict which computers can access it.  
350  
 
For more on connecting to and setting up your wireless router, see the wireless router instruction manual or  
contact its manufacturer.  
Note  
• To check the MAC address or IP address of your computer, see Checking Computer IP Address or MAC  
351  
Network Key (Password) Unknown  
WPA/WPA2 or WEP Key Set for Wireless Router Unknown, Cannot  
Connect  
For more on setting up a wireless router, see the instruction manual provided with the wireless router or  
contact its manufacturer. Make sure your computer can communicate with the wireless router.  
Note  
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.  
Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.  
Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.  
• For Windows:  
Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
• For macOS:  
Setting an Encryption Key  
For more on setting up a wireless router, see the instruction manual provided with the wireless router or  
contact its manufacturer. Make sure your computer can communicate with the wireless router.  
Note  
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.  
Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.  
Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.  
• For Windows:  
Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
• For macOS:  
352  
     
Selecting WPA, WPA2, or WPA/WPA2 is recommended for security reason. If your wireless router is  
compatible with WPA/WPA2, you can also use WPA2 or WPA.  
Using WPA/WPA2 (Windows)  
The authentication method, Wi-Fi password, and dynamic encryption type must be identical among  
the wireless router, the printer, and your computer.  
Enter the Wi-Fi password configured on the wireless router.  
Either TKIP (basic encryption) or AES (secure encryption) is selected automatically as the dynamic  
encryption method.  
For details, see If WPA/WPA2 Details Screen Appears.  
Note  
• This printer supports WPA/WPA2-PSK (WPA/WPA2-Personal) and WPA2-PSK (WPA2-  
Personal).  
Using WEP  
The length or format of the Wi-Fi password and authentication method must be identical among the  
wireless router, the printer, and your computer.  
To communicate with a wireless router that generates a password automatically, you must set the  
printer to use the password generated by the wireless router.  
◦ For Windows:  
When the WEP Details screen appears after you click Search... on the Network Settings (Wi-Fi)  
screen in IJ Network Device Setup Utility, follow the on-screen instructions to set the password  
length, format, and the password to use.  
For details, see If WEP Details Screen Appears.  
Note  
• If the printer is connected to an AirPort Base Station via LAN:  
If the printer is connected to an AirPort Base Station via a LAN, check the settings in Wireless  
Security of AirPort Utility.  
• Select 64 bit if WEP 40 bit is selected for password length in AirPort Base Station.  
• Select 1 for the password to use. Otherwise, computer will not be able to communicate with  
printer via the wireless router.  
353  
Printer Cannot Be Used After Replacing Wireless Router or  
Changed Router Settings  
When you replace a wireless router, redo the network setup for the printer according to the replaced one.  
• For Windows:  
Perform setup using the Setup CD-ROM or from the web page.  
• For macOS:  
Perform setup from the web page.  
Note  
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.  
Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.  
Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.  
• For Windows:  
Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
• For macOS:  
If this does not solve the problem, see below.  
Cannot Communicate with Printer After Enabling MAC/IP Address  
Filtering or Encryption Key on Wireless Router  
Check1  
Check wireless router setting.  
To check the wireless router setting, see the instruction manual provided with the wireless router or contact its  
manufacturer. Make sure the computer and the wireless router can communicate with each other under this  
setting.  
354  
   
Check2  
If filtering MAC addresses or IP addresses at wireless router, check that MAC  
addresses or IP addresses for computer, network device, and printer are registered.  
Check3  
If using WPA/WPA2 key or a password, make sure encryption key for  
computer, network device, and printer matches key set for wireless router.  
The length or format of the Wi-Fi password and authentication method must be identical among the wireless  
router, the printer, and your computer.  
For details, see Setting an Encryption Key.  
With Encryption On, Cannot Communicate with Printer After  
Changing Encryption Type at Wireless Router  
If you change the encryption type for the printer and it subsequently cannot communicate with the  
computer, make sure the encryption type for the computer and the wireless router matches the type set  
for the printer.  
355  
 
Checking Network Information  
Checking Printer IP Address or MAC Address  
To check the printer's IP Address or MAC address, print out the network settings information.  
For Windows, you can check the network setting information on the computer screen.  
Canon IJ Network Device Setup Utility Screen  
Checking Computer IP Address or MAC Address  
To check the IP Address or MAC address of your computer, follow the instructions below.  
• For Windows:  
1. Select Command Prompt as shown below.  
In Windows 10, right-click Start and select Command Prompt.  
In Windows 8.1, select Command Prompt from the Start screen. If Command Prompt is not  
displayed on the Start screen, select the Search charm and search for "Command Prompt".  
In Windows 7, click Start > All Programs > Accessories > Command Prompt.  
2. Enter "ipconfig/all" and press Enter.  
The IP address and MAC address of your computer appear. If your computer is not connected to a  
network, the IP address does not appear.  
• For macOS:  
1. Select System Preferences from Apple menu, and then click Network.  
2. Make sure network interface used by computer is selected, and then click Advanced.  
Make sure Wi-Fi is selected as network interface.  
3. Click TCP/IP to check the IP address, or click Hardware to check the MAC address.  
357  
     
Checking Communication Between the Computer, the Printer, and the  
Wireless Router  
Perform a ping test to check if communication is taking place.  
• For Windows:  
1. Select Command Prompt as shown below.  
In Windows 10, right-click Start and select Command Prompt.  
In Windows 8.1, select Command Prompt from the Start screen. If Command Prompt is not  
displayed on the Start screen, select the Search charm and search for "Command Prompt".  
In Windows 7, click Start > All Programs > Accessories > Command Prompt.  
2. Type the ping command and press Enter.  
The ping command is as follows: ping XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX  
"XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX" is the IP address of the target device.  
If communication is taking place, a message like the one shown below appears.  
Reply from XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX: bytes=32 time=10ms TTL=255  
If Request timed out appears, communication is not taking place.  
• For macOS:  
1. Start Network Utility as shown below.  
Select Computer from Go menu of Finder, double-click Macintosh HD > System > Library >  
CoreServices > Applications > Network Utility.  
2. Click Ping.  
3. Make sure Send only XX pings (XX are numbers) is selected.  
4. Enter IP address of target printer or target wireless router in Enter the network  
address to ping.  
5. Click Ping.  
"XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX" is the IP address of the target device.  
A message such as the following appears.  
64 bytes from XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX: icmp_seq=0 ttl=64 time=3.394 ms  
64 bytes from XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX: icmp_seq=1 ttl=64 time=1.786 ms  
64 bytes from XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX: icmp_seq=2 ttl=64 time=1.739 ms  
358  
 
--- XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX ping statistics ---  
3 packets transmitted, 3 packets received, 0% packet loss  
If packet loss is 100%, communication is not taking place. Otherwise, computer is communicating  
with target device.  
Checking Network Setting Information  
To check the printer's network settings information, print out the network settings information.  
359  
 
Restoring to Factory Defaults  
Important  
• For Windows:  
Initialization erases all network settings on the printer, making printing, scanning, or faxing operation  
from a computer over a network impossible. To use the printer over a network again after restoring it to  
the factory defaults, redo setup using the Setup CD-ROM or from the web page.  
• For macOS:  
Initialization erases all network settings on the printer, making printing, scanning, or faxing operation  
from a computer over a network impossible. To use the printer over a network again after restoring it to  
the factory defaults, redo setup from the web page.  
Initialize the network setting using the printer's operation panel.  
360  
 
Problems while Printing/Scanning from Smartphone/Tablet  
361  
 
Cannot Print/Scan from Smartphone/Tablet  
If you cannot print/scan from your smartphone/tablet, it is possible that your smartphone/tablet cannot  
communicate with the printer.  
Check the cause of your problem according to the connection method.  
Note  
• For problems on printing with other connection methods or more on performing settings of each  
connection method:  
Using PIXMA/MAXIFY Cloud Link  
Printing with Google Cloud Print  
Printing from iOS Device (AirPrint)  
Cannot Communicate with Printer over Wireless LAN  
If your smartphone/tablet cannot communicate with the printer, check the following.  
Check1  
Check the power status of printer, network devices (e.g. wireless router), and  
smartphone/tablet.  
• Turn on the printer or devices.  
• If the power is already turned on, cycle the power switch.  
• It may be necessary to resolve wireless router problems (e.g. update interval of a key, problems of DHCP  
update interval, energy saving mode, etc.) or to update the wireless router firmware.  
For details, contact the manufacturer of your wireless router.  
Check2  
Check the settings of your device (smartphone/tablet).  
Make sure Wi-Fi is enabled on your device.  
For details, refer to your device's instruction manual.  
Check3  
Is the printer connected to the wireless router?  
Use the icon on the LCD to check the connection status between the printer and wireless router. If the  
icon is not displayed, Wi-Fi is disabled. Turn on wireless communication on the printer.  
Check4  
Are network settings of printer identical with those of wireless router?  
Make sure the network settings of the printer (e.g. network name (SSID) or network key (password), etc.) are  
identical with those of the wireless router.  
To check the settings of the wireless router, refer to the instruction manual provided with it or contact its  
manufacturer.  
362  
   
To check the current network settings of the printer, print out the network setting information.  
Note  
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.  
Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.  
Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.  
• For Windows:  
Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
• For macOS:  
Check5  
Are network settings of your smartphone/tablet identical with those of wireless  
router?  
Make sure the network settings of the printer (e.g. network name (SSID) or network key (password), etc.) are  
identical with those of the wireless router.  
To check the settings of your smartphone/tablet, refer to the instruction manual provided with it.  
If the network settings of your smartphone/tablet are not identical with those of the wireless router, change the  
network settings of it to match with those of the wireless router.  
Check6  
Make sure the printer is not placed too far away from the wireless router.  
If the distance between the printer and wireless router is too far, wireless communication becomes poor. Place  
the printer and wireless router close to each other.  
Note  
• Though an antenna is attached to most wireless routers, note that some of them have it inside.  
Check7  
Make sure wireless signal is strong. Monitor signal status and move printer  
and wireless router as necessary.  
Place the printer and wireless router where there are no obstacles between them. Wireless communication  
between different rooms or floors is generally poor. Wireless communication can be impeded by building  
materials containing metal or concrete. If the printer cannot communicate with the computer over a Wi-Fi due  
to a wall, place the printer and the computer in the same room.  
In addition, if a device like a microwave oven that emits radio waves of the same frequency bandwidth as a  
wireless router is nearby, it may cause interference. Place the wireless router as far away from interference  
sources as possible.  
Check the signal strength on the LCD.  
Note  
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.  
363  
Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.  
Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.  
• For Windows:  
Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility  
• For macOS:  
Cannot Communicate with Printer while It Is in Wireless Direct  
If your smartphone/tablet cannot communicate with the printer in the Wireless Direct, check the following.  
Check1  
Check the power status of printer and other devices (smartphone or tablet).  
Turn on the printer or devices.  
If the power is already turned on, cycle the power switch.  
Check2  
Is Wireless Direct enabled?  
From the Setup menu screen, select Device settings > LAN settings > Wireless Direct > Switch WL  
Direct in this order and select Yes.  
Check3  
Check the settings of your device (smartphone/tablet).  
Make sure Wi-Fi is enabled on your device.  
For details, refer to your device's instruction manual.  
Check4  
Make sure printer is selected as connection for device (e.g. smartphone or  
tablet).  
Select the network name (SSID) for Wireless Direct specified for the printer as the connection destination for  
devices.  
Check the destination on your device.  
For details, refer to your device's instruction manual or visit the manufacturer's website.  
To check the network name (SSID) for Wireless Direct specified for the printer, print out the network setting  
information of the printer.  
Check5  
Have you entered the proper password specified for the Wireless Direct?  
To check the password specified for the printer, print out the network setting information of the printer.  
364  
 
Check6  
Make sure the printer is not placed too far away from the device.  
If the distance between the printer and device is too far, wireless communication becomes poor. Place the  
printer and device close to each other.  
Check7  
Make sure 5 devices are already connected.  
Wireless Direct does not allow more than 5 devices to be connected.  
365  
Printer Does Not Print  
Check1  
Make sure printer is turned on.  
If not, make sure the printer is securely plugged in and press ON button to turn on.  
The ON lamp flashes while the printer is initializing. Wait until the ON lamp stops flashing and remains lit.  
Note  
• If you are printing large data such as photos or other graphics, printing may take longer to start. The ON  
lamp flashes while the computer is processing data and sending it to the printer. Wait until printing starts.  
Check2  
Make sure printer is properly connected to computer.  
If you are using a USB cable, make sure it is securely connected to both the printer and the computer. When the  
USB cable is securely plugged in, check the following:  
• If you are using a relay device such as a USB hub, disconnect it, connect the printer directly to the  
computer, and retry the printing. If printing starts normally, there is a problem with the relay device. Contact  
the vendor of the relay device.  
• There could also be a problem with the USB cable. Replace the USB cable and retry the printing.  
If you use the printer over a LAN, make sure the printer is correctly set up for network use.  
Note  
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status. Download it from the  
web page.  
For Windows  
For macOS  
Check3  
Make sure paper settings match information set for cassette.  
If the paper settings do not match the information set for the cassette, an error message appears on the LCD.  
Follow the instructions on the LCD to solve the problem.  
Note  
• You can select whether the message which prevents misprinting is displayed.  
• To change the message view setting when printing or copying using the printer's operation panel:  
• To change the message view setting when printing using the printer driver:  
Changing the Printer Operation Mode (Windows)  
367  
 
Check4  
If printing from a computer, delete jobs stuck in print queue.  
• For Windows:  
Deleting the Undesired Print Job  
• For macOS:  
Check5  
Is your printer's printer driver selected when printing?  
The printer will not print properly if you are using a printer driver for a different printer.  
• For Windows:  
Make sure "Canon XXX series" (where "XXX" is your printer's name) is selected in the Print dialog box.  
Note  
• If multiple printers are registered to your computer, select Set as Default Printer for a printer to make  
the one selected by default.  
• For macOS:  
Make sure your printer's name is selected in Printer in the Print dialog.  
Note  
• If multiple printers are registered to your computer, select Set as Default Printer from System  
Preferences > Printers & Scanners for a printer to make the one selected by default.  
Check6  
Are you trying to print a large data file? (Windows)  
If you are trying to print a large file, it takes a long time to start printing.  
If the printer does not start printing after a certain period of time, select On for Prevention of Print Data Loss.  
For details, refer to Page Setup Tab Description.  
Important  
• Selecting On for Prevention of Print Data Loss may reduce print quality.  
• After printing is completed, select Off for Prevention of Print Data Loss.  
Check7  
Restart the computer and try printing again.  
If printing from a computer, restart the computer.  
368  
Ink Does Not Come Out  
Check1  
Make sure of the estimated ink levels in the FINE cartridges.  
Replace empty FINE cartridges with new ones.  
Check2  
Is the FINE cartridge installed properly?  
If the FINE cartridge is not installed securely, ink may not be ejected correctly.  
Open the paper output cover and remove the FINE cartridges.  
Then install the FINE cartridges again. Push up the FINE cartridge until it clicks into place.  
After confirming that the FINE cartridge is installed properly, close the paper output cover.  
Check3  
Are the print head nozzles clogged?  
Print the nozzle check pattern to determine whether the ink ejects properly from the print head nozzles.  
For details on printing the nozzle check pattern, print head cleaning, and print head deep cleaning, see If Printing  
• If nozzle check pattern is not printed correctly:  
After performing the print head cleaning, print the nozzle check pattern and examine the pattern.  
• If problem is not resolved after performing print head cleaning twice:  
Perform print head deep cleaning.  
369  
 
If the problem is not resolved after performing print head deep cleaning, turn off the printer and perform  
print head deep cleaning again 24 hours later. When you turn the printer off, do not unplug it from the power  
supply.  
• If problem is not resolved after performing print head deep cleaning twice:  
Ink may have run out. Replace the FINE cartridge.  
370  
Paper Does Not Feed Properly/"No Paper" Error  
Check1  
Make sure paper is loaded.  
Check2  
When loading paper, consider the following.  
• When loading two or more sheets of paper, flip through the paper before loading it.  
• When loading two or more sheets of paper, align the edges of the sheets before loading the paper.  
• When loading two or more sheets of paper, make sure the paper stack does not exceed the paper load  
limit.  
However, paper may not feed correctly at the maximum capacity, depending on the type of paper or  
environmental conditions (very high or low temperature and humidity). In such cases, reduce the amount of  
paper you load at a time to less than half of the paper load limit.  
• Always load the paper in portrait orientation, regardless of the printing orientation.  
• When you load the paper, load the paper with the print side facing DOWN and slide the paper guides to  
align with the both sides of the paper.  
• When you load the paper, insert the paper stack until the leading edge touches the far end of the cassette.  
Check3  
Is paper too thick or curled?  
Check4  
When loading envelopes, consider the following.  
When printing on envelopes, see Loading Envelopes, and prepare the envelopes before printing.  
Once you have prepared the envelopes, load them in portrait orientation. If the envelopes are placed in  
landscape orientation, they will not feed properly.  
Check5  
Push the cassette so that the  
Is the cassette set properly?  
mark on the cassette aligns with the front panel as illustrated below.  
371  
 
Check6  
Check7  
Make sure media type and paper size settings match with loaded paper.  
If multiple sheets of plain paper is fed from the printer, select the setting for  
preventing double-feed of plain paper.  
If multiple sheets of plain paper is fed from the printer, select the setting for preventing double-feed of plain paper  
using the operation panel or your computer.  
* After printing is finished, disable the setting for preventing double-feed of plain paper; otherwise, the setting is  
applied from the next time.  
• To set by using the operation panel  
Press the Setup button, select Device settings and Print settings in this order, and then set Prevent  
double-feed to ON.  
• To set by using your computer (Windows)  
1. Open Canon IJ Printer Assistant Tool.  
Maintenance Tab Description  
2. Select Select Printer... and select printer you are using from pulldown menu and select  
OK.  
3. Select Custom Settings.  
4. Select the Prevent paper double-feed check box.  
5. Select OK on the displayed screen.  
6. Select OK.  
7. Select OK on the displayed screen.  
Check8  
Clean paper feed roller.  
372  
If the measures above do not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a  
repair.  
373  
Printout Results Are Unsatisfactory  
If the print results are unsatisfactory due to white streaks, misaligned/distorted lines, or uneven colors, check  
the paper and print quality settings first.  
Check1  
Do page size and media type settings match size and type of loaded paper?  
If these settings do not match, it is not possible to obtain the proper result.  
If you are printing a photograph or an illustration, an incorrect paper type setting may reduce the quality of the  
printout color.  
Also, if you print with an incorrect paper type setting, the printed surface may be scratched.  
In borderless printing, uneven coloring may occur depending on the combination of the paper type setting and  
the loaded paper.  
The method for checking the paper and print quality settings differs depending on what you are using your printer  
for.  
• Copying  
Check the settings using the operation panel.  
• Printing from your computer  
Check the settings using the printer driver.  
Basic Printing Setup  
• Printing from your smartphone/tablet using Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY  
Check the settings on Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY.  
Print Easily from a Smartphone or Tablet with Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY  
Check2  
Make sure appropriate print quality is selected (see list above).  
Select a print quality suited to the paper and to what you are printing. If you notice blurs or uneven colors,  
increase the print quality setting and retry the printing.  
Check3  
If problem is not resolved, check also the sections below.  
See also the sections below:  
Cannot Complete Printing  
Part of Page Is Not Printed (Windows)  
374  
 
Lines Incomplete or Missing (Windows)  
Images Incomplete or Missing (Windows)  
Ink Blots / Paper Curl  
Back of Paper Is Smudged  
Uneven or Streaked Colors  
If Printed Paper Has Been Discolored  
Colors may fade with time if the printed paper is left for a long period of time.  
After printing, dry the paper sufficiently, avoid high temperatures, high humidity, and direct sunlight, and  
store or display indoors at room temperature and normal humidity.  
To avoid direct exposure to air, we recommend that you store the paper in an album, plastic folder, photo  
frame, etc.  
375  
Printouts Are Blank/Blurry or Fuzzy/Inaccurate or Bleeding Colors/  
Streaks or Lines  
Printing Is Blurry  
Colors Are Wrong  
376  
 
White Streaks Appear  
Check1  
Check2  
Check paper and print quality settings.  
Make sure of the estimated ink levels in the FINE cartridges.  
Replace empty FINE cartridges with new ones.  
Check3  
Are the print head nozzles clogged?  
Print the nozzle check pattern to determine whether the ink ejects properly from the print head nozzles.  
For details on printing the nozzle check pattern, print head cleaning, and print head deep cleaning, see If Printing  
• If nozzle check pattern is not printed correctly:  
After performing the print head cleaning, print the nozzle check pattern and examine the pattern.  
• If problem is not resolved after performing print head cleaning twice:  
Perform print head deep cleaning.  
If the problem is not resolved after performing print head deep cleaning, turn off the printer and perform  
print head deep cleaning again 24 hours later. When you turn the printer off, do not unplug it from the power  
supply.  
• If problem is not resolved after performing print head deep cleaning twice:  
Ink may have run out. Replace the FINE cartridge.  
Check4  
When using paper with one printable surface, make sure paper is loaded with  
printable side facing down.  
Printing on the wrong side of such paper may cause unclear prints or prints with reduced quality.  
Load paper with the printable side facing up.  
Refer to the instruction manual supplied with the paper for detailed information on the printable side.  
377  
Check5  
Is the FINE cartridge installed properly?  
If the FINE cartridge is not installed securely, ink may not be ejected correctly.  
Open the paper output cover and remove the FINE cartridges.  
Then install the FINE cartridges again. Push up the FINE cartridge until it clicks into place.  
After confirming that the FINE cartridge is installed properly, close the paper output cover.  
When copying, see also the sections below:  
Check6  
Is platen glass or glass of ADF dirty?  
Clean the platen glass or the glass of ADF.  
Cleaning Platen and Document Cover  
Cleaning the ADF (Auto Document Feeder)  
Note  
• If the glass of ADF is dirty, black streaks appear on the paper as shown below.  
Check7  
Make sure original is properly loaded on platen or ADF.  
When you load the original on the platen, load it with the side to be copied facing down.  
When you load the original on the ADF, load it with the side to be copied facing up.  
378  
Check8  
Is copy source a printed paper by printer?  
If you use a printout done by this printer as the original, print quality may be reduced depending on the condition  
of the original.  
Print from the printer directly, or reprint from the computer if you can reprint from it.  
379  
Colors Are Unclear  
Check1  
Are the print head nozzles clogged?  
Print the nozzle check pattern to determine whether the ink ejects properly from the print head nozzles.  
For details on printing the nozzle check pattern, print head cleaning, and print head deep cleaning, see If Printing  
• If nozzle check pattern is not printed correctly:  
After performing the print head cleaning, print the nozzle check pattern and examine the pattern.  
• If problem is not resolved after performing print head cleaning twice:  
Perform print head deep cleaning.  
If the problem is not resolved after performing print head deep cleaning, turn off the printer and perform  
print head deep cleaning again 24 hours later. When you turn the printer off, do not unplug it from the power  
supply.  
• If problem is not resolved after performing print head deep cleaning twice:  
Ink may have run out. Replace the FINE cartridge.  
Check2  
When a FINE cartridge runs out of ink, replace it with a new one.  
Check3  
Is the FINE cartridge installed properly?  
If the FINE cartridge is not installed securely, ink may not be ejected correctly.  
Open the paper output cover and remove the FINE cartridges.  
Then install the FINE cartridges again. Push up the FINE cartridge until it clicks into place.  
380  
 
After confirming that the FINE cartridge is installed properly, close the paper output cover.  
Note  
• Printed colors may not match screen colors due to basic differences in the methods used to produce  
colors. Color control settings and environmental differences can also affect how colors appear on the  
screen. Therefore, colors of printing results may be different from those on the screen.  
381  
Lines Are Misaligned/Distorted  
Check1  
Perform print head alignment.  
If printed lines are misaligned/distorted or print results are otherwise unsatisfactory, adjust the print head  
position.  
Note  
• If the problem is not resolved after performing the print head alignment, perform print head alignment  
manually from your computer.  
• For Windows:  
Adjusting Print Head Position Manually  
• For macOS:  
Check2  
Check paper and print quality settings.  
Check3  
Increase print quality and try printing again.  
Increasing the print quality may improve the print result.  
382  
 
Paper Is Smudged / Printed Surface Is Scratched  
Paper Is Smudged  
Smudged Edges  
Smudged Surface  
Printed Surface Is Scratched  
Check1  
Check paper and print quality settings.  
Check2  
Check paper type.  
Make sure you are using the right paper for what you are printing.  
Check3  
Correct curl before loading paper.  
When using Photo Paper Plus Semi-gloss, even if the sheet is curled, load one sheet at a time as it is. Rolling  
this paper in the opposite direction to flatten it may crack the paper surface and reduce the print quality.  
We recommend putting unused paper back into the package and storing it flat.  
Plain Paper  
Turn the paper over and reload it to print on the other side.  
Other Paper such as envelope  
If the paper corners curl more than 0.1 inch / 3 mm (A) in height, the paper may smudge or may not feed  
properly. Follow the instructions below to correct the paper curl.  
383  
 
1. Roll up paper in opposite direction to paper curl as shown below.  
2. Check that paper is now flat.  
We recommend printing curl-corrected paper one sheet at a time.  
Note  
• Depending on paper type, the paper may smudge or may not feed properly even if it is not curled inward.  
Follow the instructions below to curl the paper outward up to 0.1 inch / 3 mm (B) in height before printing.  
This may improve the print result.  
(C) Print side  
We recommend feeding paper that has been curled outward one sheet at a time.  
Check4  
Set printer to prevent paper abrasion.  
Adjusting the setting to prevent paper abrasion will widen the clearance between the print head and the paper. If  
you notice abrasion even with the media type set correctly to match the paper, set the printer to prevent paper  
abrasion using the operation panel or the computer.  
This may reduce the print speed.  
* Once you have finished printing, undo this setting. Otherwise, it will apply to subsequent print jobs.  
• From operation panel  
Press the Setup button and select Device settings > Print settings in this order, and then set Prevent  
abrasion to ON.  
• From computer  
◦ For Windows:  
1. Make sure printer is turned on.  
384  
2. Open Canon IJ Printer Assistant Tool.  
Maintenance Tab Description  
3. Select Select Printer... and select printer you are using from pulldown menu and select  
OK.  
4. Select Custom Settings.  
5. Select Prevent paper abrasion check box and click OK.  
◦ For macOS:  
Adjust the setting to prevent paper abrasion from Remote UI.  
Check5  
If intensity is set high, reduce intensity setting and try printing again.  
If you are printing with a high intensity setting on plain paper, the paper may absorb too much ink and become  
wavy, causing paper abrasion.  
• Printing from your computer (Windows)  
Check the intensity setting in the printer driver.  
Adjusting Intensity  
• Copying  
Check6  
Is platen glass or glass of ADF dirty?  
Clean the platen glass or the glass of ADF.  
Cleaning Platen and Document Cover  
Cleaning the ADF (Auto Document Feeder)  
Note  
• If the glass of ADF is dirty, black streaks appear on the paper as shown below.  
Check7  
Is paper feed roller dirty?  
Clean paper feed roller.  
Check8  
Is inside of printer dirty?  
385  
During duplex printing, ink may stain the inside of the printer, smudging the printout.  
Perform bottom plate cleaning to clean inside of printer.  
Note  
• To prevent staining inside the printer, be sure to set the correct paper size.  
Check9  
Set longer ink drying time.  
This allows the printed surface to dry, preventing smudges and scratches.  
• For Windows:  
1. Make sure printer is turned on.  
2. Open Canon IJ Printer Assistant Tool.  
Maintenance Tab Description  
3. Select Select Printer... and select printer you are using from pulldown menu and select  
OK.  
4. Select Custom Settings.  
5. Drag Ink Drying Wait Time slide bar to set the wait time and click OK.  
6. Check message and click OK.  
• For macOS:  
Set the waiting time using Remote UI.  
386  
Vertical Line Next to Image  
Check  
Is loaded paper size correct?  
If the loaded paper is larger than the size you specified, a vertical line may appear in the margin.  
Set the paper size to match the loaded paper.  
Note  
• The direction of the vertical line pattern may vary depending on the image data or the print setting.  
• This printer performs automatic cleaning when necessary to keep printouts clean. A small amount of ink is  
ejected for cleaning.  
Although the ink is normally ejected onto the ink absorber at the outer edge of the paper, it may get onto  
the paper if the loaded paper is larger than the set size.  
387  
 
Scanning Problems (macOS)  
388  
 
Scanner Does Not Work  
Check 1  
Check that your scanner or printer is turned on.  
Check 2  
With network connection, check the connection status and reconnect as  
needed.  
Check 3  
With USB connection, connect the USB cable to a different USB port on the  
If the USB cable is connected to a USB hub, remove it from the USB hub and  
computer.  
Check 4  
connect it to a USB port on the computer.  
Check 5  
Restart the computer.  
Check 6  
To scan from the printer's operation panel with USB connection, click Scan-  
from-Operation-Panel Settings in the Settings (General Settings) dialog, and then  
check that the following checkboxes are selected.  
• Your scanner or printer  
Enables scanning from the operation panel  
390  
 
Scanner Driver Does Not Start  
Check 1  
Check 2  
Make sure the application software supports AirPrint.  
Select your scanner or printer on the application's menu.  
Note  
• The operation may differ depending on the application.  
Check 3  
Scan and save images with IJ Scan Utility Lite and open the files in your  
application.  
Check 4  
Your scanner may be locked. (Personal scanners only)  
If IJ Scan Utility Lite or the application is running, exit it. Slide the scanner lock switch to the release position  
), then reconnect the USB cable.  
(
391  
 
Cannot Send a Fax  
Check1  
Is power turned on?  
• You cannot send faxes if the power is turned off. Press the ON button to turn the power on.  
• If you unplugged the power cord without turning off the power (the ON lamp is lit), reconnecting it turns on  
the power automatically.  
• If you unplugged the power cord after pressing the ON button to turn off the power (the ON lamp is off),  
reconnect it, and then press the ON button to turn on the power.  
• If the power was turned off due to power failure, etc., the power is automatically turned on when the power  
failure is resolved.  
Important  
• Confirm that the ON lamp is off before unplugging the power cord, and then unplug the power cord.  
If a power failure occurs or you unplug the power cord, all faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.  
For details on how to unplug the power cord, see Unplugging the Printer.  
Note  
• If the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted by a power failure or unplugging the power cord, the  
list of the faxes deleted from the printer's memory (MEMORY CLEAR REPORT) will be printed after turning  
the printer on.  
Summary of Reports and Lists  
Check2  
Is document being sent from memory or the fax being received into memory?  
When the message for the transmission/reception is displayed on the Fax standby screen, a fax is being sent  
from/received into printer's memory. Wait until the transmission/reception is complete.  
Check3  
Is printer's memory full?  
Delete contents in memory, and then send a fax again.  
Check4  
Is telephone line type set correctly?  
Check the telephone line type setting and change it as necessary.  
Check5  
Is Hook setting set to Disable?  
When you send a fax manually, dial the number with Enable selected for Hook setting in Security control  
under Fax settings, or dial the number using the telephone connected to the printer.  
394  
 
Check6  
Is Dial tone detect set to ON?  
Resend the fax after a while.  
If you still cannot send the fax, select OFF for Dial tone detect in Adv. FAX settings under Fax settings.  
Check7  
Is fax number registered correctly in printer's directory?  
Check the recipient's fax/telephone number, correct the fax/telephone number registered in the printer's  
directory, and then send the document again.  
Note  
• You can check the registered information in the printer's directory by printing RECIPIENT TELEPHONE  
NUMBER LIST.  
Summary of Reports and Lists  
Check8  
Does an error occur during transmission?  
• Ensure that a message is displayed on the Fax standby screen. When a message is displayed on the Fax  
standby screen, check the cause.  
A Message for Faxing Is Displayed on the LCD  
• Print ACTIVITY REPORT and check for an error.  
Summary of Reports and Lists  
If a transmission error has occurred, see below.  
Check9  
Is document loaded properly?  
Remove the document, and then reload it on the platen or in the ADF.  
Check10  
Does a printer error occur?  
Ensure that an error message is displayed on the LCD. When an error message is displayed on the LCD, check  
the cause.  
When the error message and support code are displayed, refer to List of Support Code for Error.  
When only the error message is displayed, refer to Message (Support Code) Appears.  
If you are in a hurry, press the Stop button to close the message, and then send the fax.  
Check11  
Is telephone line connected correctly?  
Reconnect the telephone line cable to the telephone line jack.  
395  
If the telephone line is connected correctly, there is a problem with your telephone line. Contact your telephone  
company and the manufacturer of your terminal adapter or telephone adapter.  
396  
Errors Often Occur When Send a Fax  
Check  
Check telephone line condition or connection.  
If errors occur frequently when using an Internet telephone, it is possible that they can be reduced by selecting  
Reduce for Err reduction (VoIP) on Adv. FAX settings under Fax settings.  
For details, see Err reduction (VoIP).  
Note  
• If selecting Reduce does not reduce errors, select Do not reduce.  
In addition, when using an Internet telephone, it is possible that errors occur more often if 4800 bps or 9600 bps  
is selected for TX start speed. Select 14400 bps or 33600 bps.  
If the telephone line or connection is poor when using a general telephone, reducing the transmission start speed  
may correct the error.  
Reduce the transmission start speed on TX start speed in Adv. communication in Adv. FAX settings under  
Fax settings.  
397  
 
Problems Receiving Faxes  
398  
 
Cannot Receive a Fax, Cannot Print a Fax  
Check1  
Is power turned on?  
• You cannot receive faxes if the power is turned off. Press the ON button to turn the power on.  
• If you unplugged the power cord without turning off the power (the ON lamp is lit), reconnecting it turns on  
the power automatically.  
• If you unplugged the power cord after pressing the ON button to turn off the power (the ON lamp is off),  
reconnect it, and then press the ON button to turn on the power.  
• If the power was turned off due to power failure, etc., the power is automatically turned on when the power  
failure is resolved.  
Important  
• Confirm that the ON lamp is off before unplugging the power cord, and then unplug the power cord.  
If a power failure occurs or you unplug the power cord, all faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.  
For details on how to unplug the power cord, see Unplugging the Printer.  
Note  
• If the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted by a power failure or unplugging the power cord, the  
list of the faxes deleted from the printer's memory (MEMORY CLEAR REPORT) will be printed after turning  
the printer on.  
Summary of Reports and Lists  
Check2  
Is the printer's memory full?  
Print the received faxes stored in the printer's memory or save them on the memory card, and then delete them  
from the printer's memory and have the sender resend the faxes.  
Check3  
Does an error occur during reception?  
• Ensure that a message is displayed on the Fax standby screen. When a message is displayed on the Fax  
standby screen, check the cause.  
A Message for Faxing Is Displayed on the LCD  
• Print ACTIVITY REPORT and check for an error.  
Summary of Reports and Lists  
If a reception error has occurred, see below.  
Errors Often Occur When Received a Fax  
Check4  
Is telephone line cable connected to external device jack?  
399  
 
Reconnect it to the telephone line jack.  
Check5  
Is paper loaded?  
If paper is not loaded, received faxes will be stored in the printer's memory without being printed (Memory  
Reception). Load paper, and then press the OK button.  
Check6  
Is a different size of paper from that specified by Page size in FAX paper  
settings loaded?  
If a different size of paper from that specified by Page size is loaded for printing faxes, the received faxes will not  
be printed and will be stored in the printer's memory (Memory Reception). Load the same size of paper as that  
specified by Page size, then press the OK button.  
Check7  
Is amount of remaining ink sufficient to print a fax?  
If the amount of remaining ink is insufficient to print, received faxes will be stored in the printer's memory without  
being printed (Memory Reception). Replace the FINE cartridge, and then print the faxes in the printer's memory.  
Note  
• If the printer was receiving faxes in the fax mode, printing will start automatically after the FINE cartridge is  
replaced.  
• When the printer receives black & white faxes in the printer's memory, if ON is selected for 2-sided in FAX  
paper settings, selecting OFF may print the faxes.  
• You can set the printer to forcibly print a received fax even if the ink has run out.  
Set Print when no ink in Auto print settings under Fax settings to Print.  
However, part or all of the fax may not be printed since the ink has run out.  
Also, the contents of the fax will not be stored in the printer's memory.  
If the ink has already run out, we recommend that Do not print be selected for Received documents in  
Auto print settings under Fax settings to store the received fax in the printer's memory. After you replace  
the FINE cartridge and select Print for Received documents in Auto print settings, the fax stored in the  
printer's memory will be printed automatically.  
Check8  
Is printer set to appropriate receive mode?  
Check the receive mode setting and change it to a mode suited to your connection if necessary.  
Check9  
Is FAX RX reject set to ON?  
Select OFF for FAX RX reject in Security control under Fax settings.  
For details, refer to Rejecting Fax Reception.  
400  
Check10  
Are there setting items set Reject in Caller rejection?  
If you select Reject for any setting items in Caller rejection in Security control under Fax settings, the printer  
rejects calls for setting item selected Reject.  
For details, refer to Using Caller ID Service to Reject Calls.  
401  
Cannot Dial  
Check1  
Is telephone line cable connected correctly?  
Check that the telephone line cable is connected correctly.  
Check2  
Is telephone line type of printer or external device set correctly?  
Check the telephone line type setting and change it as necessary.  
403  
 
Telephone Disconnects During a Call  
Check  
Is telephone line cable or telephone (or a peripheral device such as an external  
telephone, an answering device, or a computer modem) connected correctly?  
Check that the telephone line cable and the telephone (or a peripheral device such as an external telephone, an  
answering device, or a computer modem) are connected correctly.  
404  
 
Poor Quality Fax Received  
Check1  
Ask the sender to adjust the scan settings of the fax device.  
Check2  
Check scan settings of sender's fax device.  
Is ECM RX set to OFF?  
Select ON for ECM RX in Adv. communication in Adv. FAX settings under Fax settings.  
If ECM RX is enabled, the sender's fax device resends the fax after correcting errors automatically.  
Check3  
Is sender's original document or scanning area of sender's fax device dirty?  
The image quality of the fax is mainly determined by the sender's fax device. Contact the sender and ask the  
sender to check whether the scanning area of the fax device is dirty.  
Check4  
Is ECM transmission/reception enabled although the line/connection is poor, or  
is the sender's fax device compatible with ECM?  
• Select ON for ECM RX in Adv. communication in Adv. FAX settings under Fax settings.  
• Contact the sender and ask the sender to check whether the fax device is set to enable ECM transmission.  
If the sender's or recipient's fax device is not compatible with ECM, the fax will be sent/received without  
automatic error correction.  
• Reduce the reception start speed on RX start speed in Adv. communication in Adv. FAX settings under  
Fax settings.  
Check5  
Did you confirm paper and print quality settings?  
405  
 
Printer Does Not Turn On  
Check1  
Check2  
Press ON button.  
Make sure power plug is securely connected to printer, and then turn on again.  
Unplug printer, leave it for at least 2 minutes, and then plug it back in and turn  
Check3  
on again.  
If this does not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.  
407  
 
Printer Turns Off Unexpectedly or Repeatedly  
Check  
If printer is set to turn off automatically after a certain time, disable this setting.  
If you have set the printer to turn off automatically after a specified time, the power will shut off by itself once that  
time has elapsed.  
• To disable the setting from the operation panel:  
1. Check that printer is turned on.  
2. Press the Setup button, use the  
button to select ECO settings, and press the OK  
button.  
3. Use the  
4. Use the  
5. Use the  
button to select EnergySaveSettings and then press the OK button.  
button to select Auto power off and then press the OK button.  
button to select OFF and then press the OK button.  
The setting to shut off the power automatically is disabled.  
• To disable the setting from the computer:  
For Windows, use Canon IJ Printer Assistant Tool or ScanGear (scanner driver) to disable the setting.  
Follow the procedure below to disable the setting using Canon IJ Printer Assistant Tool.  
1. Open Canon IJ Printer Assistant Tool.  
Maintenance Tab Description  
2. Select Select Printer... and select printer you are using from pulldown menu and select  
OK.  
3. Select Auto Power.  
4. Select Disable for Auto Power Off.  
5. Select OK.  
6. Select OK on the displayed screen.  
408  
 
The setting to shut off the power automatically is disabled.  
Note  
• Refer to below to disable the setting from ScanGear (scanner driver).  
Scanner Tab  
409  
USB Connection Problems  
Printing or Scanning Is Slow/Hi-Speed USB Connection Does Not  
Work/"This device can perform faster" Message Appears (Windows)  
If your system environment does not support Hi-Speed USB, the printer operates at the slower speed of  
USB 1.1. In this case, the printer works properly but printing or scanning speed may slow down due to the  
communication speed.  
Check  
Check following to make sure your system environment supports Hi-Speed  
USB connection.  
• Does the USB port on your computer support Hi-Speed USB connection?  
• Does the USB cable or the USB hub support Hi-Speed USB connection?  
Be sure to use a certified Hi-Speed USB cable. We recommend that the USB cable be no longer than 10  
feet / 3 meters or so.  
• Is the Hi-Speed USB driver working properly on your computer?  
Make sure the latest Hi-Speed USB driver is working properly and obtain and install the latest version of  
the Hi-Speed USB driver for your computer, if necessary.  
Important  
• For more information, contact the manufacturer of your computer, USB cable, or USB hub.  
410  
 
Cannot Communicate with Printer via USB  
Check1  
Check2  
Make sure printer is turned on.  
Connect USB cable properly.  
As the illustration below, the USB port is at the back of the printer.  
Important  
• Connect the "Type-B" terminal to the printer with the notched side facing UP. For details, refer to the  
instruction manual supplied with the USB cable.  
Check3  
Make sure Enable bidirectional support is selected in the Ports sheet of the  
properties dialog box of the printer driver. (Windows)  
If not, select it to enable bidirectional support.  
Opening Printer Driver's Setup Screen  
411  
 
Wrong Language Appears in LCD  
Follow the instructions below to select your language.  
1. Press Setup button and wait a little.  
2. Press  
3. Press  
4. Use  
button twice and press OK button.  
button 3 times and press OK button.  
button to select language for LCD and press OK button.  
The desired language appears on the LCD.  
5. Press Stop button.  
412  
 
Failed to MP Drivers Installation (Windows)  
If installation does not start when you insert Setup CD-ROM:  
Follow the instructions below to start the installation.  
1. Make the following settings.  
◦ In Windows 10, click Start > File Explorer, and then click This PC from list on left.  
◦ In Windows 8.1, select Explorer icon in Taskbar on Desktop, and then select This PC from  
list on left.  
◦ In Windows 7, click Start, and then click Computer.  
2. Double-click the  
CD-ROM icon in the window that appears.  
If the contents of the CD-ROM appear, double-click MSETUP4.EXE.  
If you cannot install the MP Drivers with the Setup CD-ROM, install them from the Canon website.  
Note  
• If the CD-ROM icon does not appear, try the following:  
• Remove the CD-ROM from your computer and reinsert it.  
• Restart your computer.  
If the icon still does not appear, try a different disc and see if it appears. If it does, there is a  
problem with the Setup CD-ROM. Contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.  
414  
 
If you cannot get past the Printer Connection screen:  
Other cases:  
Reinstall the MP Drivers.  
If the MP Drivers were not installed correctly, uninstall the MP Drivers, restart your computer, and then  
reinstall the MP Drivers.  
Deleting the Unnecessary MP Drivers  
Reinstall the MP Drivers with the Setup CD-ROM or install them from the Canon website.  
Note  
• If the installer was stopped due to a Windows error, Windows operation may be unstable, and you  
may not be able to install the drivers. Restart your computer and then reinstall the drivers.  
415  
Updating MP Drivers in Network Environment (Windows)  
Download the latest MP Drivers.  
Download the latest MP Drivers for your model on the download page of the Canon website.  
Uninstall the existing MP Drivers and follow the installation instructions to install the latest MP Drivers that  
you downloaded. In the connection method selection screen, select Use the printer with Wi-Fi  
connection. The printer is detected automatically in the network.  
Make sure the printer was found, and install the MP Drivers following the on-screen instructions.  
Note  
• The network settings on the printer are not affected, so the printer can be used on the network without  
redoing settings.  
416  
 
An Error Occurs  
If an error occurs in printing, for example if the paper runs out or jams, a troubleshooting message appears  
automatically. Take the appropriate action described in the message.  
When an error occurs, a message appears on the computer, or an error code appears on the printer. For  
some errors, a support code (error number) appears on the computer screen.  
When a Support Code and a message are displayed on the computer  
screen (Windows):  
When a Support Code and a message are displayed on the printer  
(LCD):  
For details on how to resolve errors, see List of Support Code for Error.  
Note  
• For details on how to resolve errors without Support Codes, see Message (Support Code) Appears.  
418  
 
Message (Support Code) Appears  
This section describes some of the errors and messages that may appear.  
Note  
• A support code (error number) is displayed on the computer for some errors. For details on errors that  
have support code, see List of Support Code for Error.  
If a message appears on the LCD, see below.  
If a message appears on the computer, see below.  
Message Appears on LCD  
Check the message and take an appropriate action.  
Check page size Press [OK]  
The size of the loaded paper is different from that specified in the paper size setting.  
Load the same size of paper as that specified in the paper size setting and press the OK button.  
Data error Press [OK]  
A power failure has occurred or the power cord has been unplugged when the faxes are stored in the  
printer's memory.  
Important  
• If a power failure occurs or you unplug the power cord, all faxes stored in the printer's memory  
are deleted.  
• For details on how to unplug the power cord, see Unplugging the Printer.  
Press the OK button.  
After pressing the OK button, the list of the faxes deleted from the printer's memory (MEMORY  
CLEAR REPORT) will be printed.  
For details, refer to Summary of Reports and Lists.  
Cannot connect to the server; try again  
You cannot connect to the server due to some communication error.  
Press the OK button to dismiss the error and try again after a while.  
419  
   
Error Regarding Automatic Duplex Printing Is Displayed  
Check  
See Automatic Duplex Printing Problems and take the appropriate action.  
Error Regarding Power Cord Being Unplugged Is Displayed  
(Windows)  
The printer may have been unplugged while it was on.  
Check the error message that appears on the computer and click OK.  
The printer starts printing.  
See Unplugging the Printer for unplugging the power cord.  
Important  
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.  
Writing Error/Output Error/Communication Error (Windows)  
Check1  
The ON lamp flashes while the printer is initializing. Wait until the ON lamp stops flashing and remains lit.  
Check2  
If the ON lamp is off, make sure printer is plugged in and turn on.  
Make sure printer is properly connected to computer.  
If you are using a USB cable, make sure it is securely connected to both the printer and the computer. When  
the USB cable is securely plugged in, check the following:  
• If you are using a relay device such as a USB hub, disconnect it, connect the printer directly to the  
computer, and retry the printing. If printing starts normally, there is a problem with the relay device.  
Contact the vendor of the relay device.  
• There could also be a problem with the USB cable. Replace the USB cable and retry the printing.  
If you use the printer over a LAN, make sure the printer is correctly set up for network use.  
Check3  
Make sure MP Drivers are installed correctly.  
Uninstall the MP Drivers following the procedure described in Deleting the Unnecessary MP Drivers and  
reinstall them from the Setup CD-ROM or the Canon website.  
420  
       
Check4  
When printer is connected to your computer with a USB cable, check device  
status from your computer.  
Follow the procedure below to check the device status.  
1. Select Control Panel > Programs > Programs and Features.  
Note  
• If the User Account Control screen appears, select Continue.  
2. Double-click Universal Serial Bus controllers and USB Printing Support.  
If USB Printing Support Properties screen does not appear, make sure the printer is correctly connected to the computer.  
3. Click General tab and check for a device problem.  
If a device error is shown, see Windows Help to resolve it.  
Other Error Messages (Windows)  
Check  
If an error message appears outside printer status monitor, check the  
following:  
• "Could not spool successfully due to insufficient disk space"  
Delete any unnecessary files to increase the amount of free space on the disk.  
• "Could not spool successfully due to insufficient memory"  
Close other applications to increase the available memory.  
If you still cannot print, restart your computer and retry the printing.  
• "Printer driver could not be found"  
Uninstall the MP Drivers following the procedure described in Deleting the Unnecessary MP Drivers and  
reinstall them from the Setup CD-ROM or the Canon website.  
• "Could not print Application name - File name"  
Try printing again once the current job is complete.  
421  
 
List of Support Code for Error  
Support code appears on the LCD and your computer screen when errors occur.  
A "support code" is an error number, and appears along with an error message.  
When an error occurs, check the support code displayed on the LCD and on the computer screen and take  
the appropriate action in response.  
Support Code Appears on LCD and Computer Screen  
1000 to 1ZZZ  
1304 1309 1310 1401 1403 1430  
1485 15A1 15A2 1682 1684 1686  
1688 168A 1702 1703 1704 1705  
1712 1713 1714 1715 1871 1890  
2000 to 2ZZZ  
2110 2120 2700 2801 2802 2803  
3000 to 3ZZZ  
3402 3403 3404 3405 3406 3407  
340D 340E 3410 3411 3412 3413  
3434 3435 3436 3437 3438 3439  
3440 3441 3446 3447  
4000 to 4ZZZ  
4100 4103 495A  
5000 to 5ZZZ  
5205 5206 5B02 5B03 5B04 5B05  
5B12 5B13 5B14 5B15  
422  
 
6000 to 6ZZZ  
6000 6500 6800 6801 6900 6901  
6902 6910 6911 6930 6931 6932  
6933 6936 6937 6938 6939 693A  
6940 6941 6942 6943 6944 6945  
6946 6D01  
7000 to 7ZZZ  
7500 7600 7700 7800  
9000 to 9ZZZ  
9500  
For paper jam support codes, see also List of Support Code for Error (Paper Jams).  
423  
List of Support Code for Error (Paper Jams)  
If paper jams, remove it following the appropriate procedure as shown below.  
• If you can see the jammed paper at the paper output slot:  
• If you cannot see the jammed paper at the paper output slot:  
◦ If the paper fed from the cassette is jammed:  
◦ If the paper is jammed when performing automatic duplex printing:  
• If the document is jammed in the ADF:  
2801  
• If the paper tears and you cannot remove it from the paper output slot or if the paper is jammed inside  
the printer:  
• Cases other than above:  
Other Cases  
424  
 
1300  
Cause  
Paper is jammed in the paper output slot.  
What to Do  
If you can see the jammed paper at the paper output slot, remove the paper following the procedure  
below.  
Important  
• The printer cannot be turned off while it is sending or receiving a fax, or when the received fax or the  
unsent fax is stored in the printer's memory.  
Turn off the printer after making sure it has completed sending or receiving all the faxes. Do not  
unplug when turning off the printer.  
If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.  
1. Slowly pull out paper.  
Hold the paper with both hands, and pull it out slowly so as not to tear it.  
Note  
• If you cannot pull out the paper, turn the printer back on without pulling forcibly. The paper may  
be ejected automatically.  
• If paper becomes jammed during printing and you need to turn off the printer to remove it, press  
the Stop button to stop the printing before you turn off the printer.  
• If the paper tears and you cannot remove the jammed paper from the paper output slot, remove  
the paper from inside the printer.  
• If you cannot pull the paper out from the paper output slot or from inside the printer, try to pull  
the paper out from the rear side of the printer.  
2. Reload paper and press printer's OK button.  
425  
 
The printer resumes printing. Reprint the page you were printing if it was not printed properly due to  
the paper jam.  
If you turned off the printer in step 1, the print data that was sent to the printer is erased. Redo the  
printing.  
Note  
• When reloading the paper, make sure you are using suitable paper and loading it correctly.  
• We recommend using paper sizes other than A5 to print documents with photos or graphics. A5  
paper may curl and jam as it leaves the printer.  
If the measures above do not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a  
repair.  
426  
1303  
Cause  
Paper is jammed in the transport unit.  
What to Do  
1. Remove jammed paper.  
• If the paper is jammed at the paper output slot:  
• If the paper is jammed inside the printer:  
• If none of the above is applied, see Removing Jammed Paper from Rear Side to open the rear  
cover and to remove the paper.  
2. Load paper in cassette properly.  
When you push the cassette back, grab the tabs at both sides of the front cover and push the cassette  
back until the arrow ( ) on the front cover is aligned with edge of the printer.  
3. Perform printing or copying again.  
427  
 
1304  
Cause  
Paper is jammed when performing automatic duplex printing.  
What to Do  
1. Remove jammed paper.  
• If the paper is jammed at the paper output slot:  
• If the paper is jammed inside the printer:  
• If none of the above is applied, see Removing Jammed Paper from Rear Side to open the rear  
cover and to remove the paper.  
2. Load paper in cassette properly.  
When you push the cassette back, grab the tabs at both sides of the front cover and push the cassette  
back until the arrow ( ) on the front cover is aligned with edge of the printer.  
3. Perform printing or copying again.  
428  
 
Paper Is Jammed inside Printer  
If the jammed paper tears and you cannot remove the paper either from the paper output slot or from the  
transport unit, or if the jammed paper remains inside the printer, remove the paper following the procedure  
below.  
Important  
• The printer cannot be turned off while it is sending or receiving a fax, or when the received fax or the  
unsent fax is stored in the printer's memory.  
Turn off the printer after making sure it has completed sending or receiving all the faxes. Do not unplug  
when turning off the printer.  
If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.  
Note  
• If paper becomes jammed during printing and you need to turn off the printer to remove it, press the  
Stop button to stop the printing before you turn off the printer.  
1. Turn off printer and unplug it.  
2. Open paper output cover.  
Remove the paper in the cassette if any.  
Important  
• Do not touch clear film (A).  
If you soil or scratch this part by touching it with paper or your hand, it could damage the printer.  
3. Check if jammed paper is under FINE cartridge holder.  
429  
 
If the jammed paper is under the FINE cartridge holder, move the FINE cartridge holder to the far right or  
left, whichever makes it easier to remove the paper.  
When moving the FINE cartridge holder, hold the top of the FINE cartridge holder and slide it slowly to  
the far right or left.  
4. Hold jammed paper firmly in both hands.  
If the paper is rolled up, pull out it.  
5. Slowly pull out paper, so as not to tear it.  
430  
6. Make sure all jammed paper is removed.  
If the paper tears when you pull out it, a bit of paper may remain in the printer. Check the following and  
remove any remaining paper.  
• Any paper left under the FINE cartridge holder?  
• Any small bits of paper left in the printer?  
• Any paper left in the left and right empty spaces (B) in the printer?  
7. Close paper output cover.  
8. Plug printer back in and turn printer back on.  
All jobs in the print queue are canceled. Redo the printing.  
Note  
• When reloading the paper, make sure you are using suitable paper and loading it correctly. If a  
paper jam message appears on the LCD of the printer or on your computer screen when you  
resume printing after removing all the jammed paper, there may be some paper still inside the  
printer. Check the printer again for any remaining bits of paper.  
If the measures above do not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a  
repair.  
431  
Removing Jammed Paper from Rear Side  
Important  
• The printer cannot be turned off while it is sending or receiving a fax, or when the received fax or the  
unsent fax is stored in the printer's memory.  
Turn off the printer after making sure it has completed sending or receiving all the faxes. Do not unplug  
when turning off the printer.  
If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.  
Note  
• If paper becomes jammed during printing and you need to turn off the printer to remove it, press Stop  
button to stop the printing before you turn off the printer.  
1. Turn off printer and unplug it.  
2. Retract output tray extension and paper output support, close front cover.  
3. Open document cover.  
Close the document tray if it is open.  
4. Stand printer with right side of front facing down.  
Important  
• Stand the printer on a wide and flat surface such as a desk.  
• When you stand the printer, hold it securely and be careful not to hit it on a hard object.  
5. Open transport unit cover.  
When you open the transport unit cover, support the printer with your hand so that it does not fall down.  
432  
 
6. Slowly pull out paper.  
When you pull the jammed paper, support the printer with your hand so that it does not fall down.  
Note  
• If the paper is rolled up and it is difficult to remove, grasp the edges of the paper, then remove the  
jammed paper.  
7. Close transport unit cover.  
433  
Note  
• After you close the transport unit cover, take back the printer in original position at once.  
8. Plug printer back in and turn printer back on.  
If the measures above do not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a  
repair.  
434  
1003  
Cause  
Printer is out of paper, or paper does not feed.  
What to Do  
Close the paper output tray, pull the cassette out, and then load the paper.  
When you load the paper, insert the paper stack until the leading edge touches the far end of the  
cassette.  
After loading the paper, push the cassette so that the  
as illustrated below.  
mark on the cassette aligns with the front panel  
Open the paper output tray, then press the printer's OK button.  
Note  
• To cancel printing, press the printer's Stop button.  
435  
 
1200  
Cause  
Paper output cover is open.  
What to Do  
Close the paper output cover and wait for a while.  
Do not close it while you are replacing a FINE cartridge.  
436  
 
1203  
Cause  
Paper output cover is opened during printing.  
What to Do  
If paper remains inside the printer, slowly pull out the paper with both hands and close the paper output  
cover.  
Press the printer's OK button to resolve the error.  
The printer ejects one blank sheet of paper and resumes printing from the next paper.  
The printer will not reprint the page that was printed when the paper output cover is opened. Retry  
printing.  
Important  
• Do not open or close the cover during printing, as this can damage the printer.  
437  
 
1250  
Cause  
Paper output tray is closed.  
What to Do  
Open the paper output tray to resume printing.  
438  
 
1401  
Cause  
FINE cartridge is not installed.  
What to Do  
Install the FINE cartridge.  
If the error is not resolved, the FINE cartridge may be damaged. Contact your nearest Canon service  
center to request a repair.  
Important  
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.  
439  
 
1430  
Cause  
FINE cartridge cannot be recognized.  
What to Do  
Remove the FINE cartridge and reinstall it.  
If the error is not resolved, the FINE cartridge may be damaged. Replace the FINE cartridge with a new  
one.  
If this still does not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.  
Important  
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.  
440  
 
1485  
Cause  
Appropriate ink cartridge is not installed.  
What to Do  
Printing cannot be executed because the ink cartridge is not compatible with this printer.  
Install the appropriate ink cartridge.  
If you want to cancel printing, press the printer's Stop button.  
441  
 
1682  
Cause  
FINE cartridge cannot be recognized.  
What to Do  
Replace the FINE cartridge.  
If the error is not resolved, the FINE cartridge may be damaged. Contact your nearest Canon service  
center to request a repair.  
Important  
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.  
442  
 
1686  
Cause  
The ink may have run out.  
What to Do  
The function for detecting the remaining ink level will be disabled since the ink level cannot be correctly  
detected.  
If you want to continue printing without this function, press the printer's Stop button for at least 5 seconds.  
Canon recommends to use new genuine Canon cartridges in order to obtain optimum qualities.  
Please be advised that Canon shall not be liable for any malfunction or trouble caused by continuation of  
printing under the ink out condition.  
443  
 
1688  
Cause  
The ink has run out.  
What to Do  
Replace the ink cartridge and close the paper output cover.  
If printing is in progress and you want to continue printing, press the printer's Stop button for at least 5  
seconds with the ink cartridge installed. Then printing can continue under the ink out condition.  
The function for detecting the remaining ink level will be disabled.  
Replace the empty ink cartridge immediately after the printing. The resulting print quality is not  
satisfactory, if printing is continued under the ink out condition.  
444  
 
168A  
Cause  
FINE cartridge is not installed properly, or FINE cartridge not compatible with this printer is installed.  
What to Do  
Retract the output tray extension and the paper output support, open the paper output cover, and then  
remove the FINE cartridges.  
Make sure the FINE cartridge compatible with the printer is installed.  
Then install the FINE cartridges again.  
Push up the FINE cartridge until it clicks into place.  
After installing, close the paper output cover.  
445  
 
1890  
Cause  
Protective material or tape may still be attached to FINE cartridge holder.  
What to Do  
Open the paper output cover, then confirm that the protective material or the tape does not remain  
attached to the FINE cartridge holder.  
If you find the protective material or the tape remains attached, remove it, then close the paper output  
cover.  
If this does not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.  
446  
 
2110  
Cause  
Paper settings for printing or copying do not match cassette paper information set on printer.  
Note  
• See below for the correct correspondence between paper settings made on the printer driver or on  
the LCD.  
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Media Type) (Windows)  
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Paper Size) (Windows)  
• For copying, make the copy paper settings to match cassette paper information set on the printer.  
• See below for details on cassette paper information set on the printer.  
If the print or copy paper settings do not match cassette paper information set on the printer, as shown  
below, a message appears on the LCD.  
• Print settings specified on the printer driver:  
Paper size: A5  
Media type: Plain paper  
• Cassette paper information set on the printer:  
Paper size: A4  
Media type: Plain paper  
What to Do  
Press the printer's OK button to display the screen below.  
Select the appropriate action.  
Note  
• Depending on settings, some of the options below may not appear.  
Use cass. settings  
Select this option to print or copy onto the paper in the cassette without changing the paper settings.  
For example, if the print or copy paper setting is A5, and cassette paper information is set to A4, the  
A5 size setting is used to print or copy onto the paper in the cassette.  
Replace the paper  
Select this option to print after changing the paper in the cassette.  
447  
 
For example, if the print or copy paper setting is A5, and cassette paper information is set to A4,  
change the paper in the cassette to A5 paper and proceed with printing or copying.  
Once you have inserted the cassette after changing the paper, the screen for setting cassette paper  
information appears. Set paper information for the paper in the cassette.  
Note  
• If you do not know what paper information to set, press the Back button. The previous screen  
appears, showing the paper size and media type. Check the paper settings and set them as cassette  
paper information.  
• See below for the correct correspondence between paper settings made on the printer driver or on  
the LCD.  
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Media Type) (Windows)  
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Paper Size) (Windows)  
Cancel  
Cancels printing.  
Select this option when you want to change the print or copy paper settings. Change the paper  
settings and retry printing.  
Note  
• To suppress the misprint prevention message, change the setting as described below. When you  
suppress the message, the printer uses the paper settings for printing or copying onto the paper in  
the cassette regardless of whether or not the paper matches these settings.  
• To change the message view setting when printing or copying using the operation panel of the  
printer:  
• To change the message view setting when printing using the printer driver:  
Changing the Printer Operation Mode (Windows)  
448  
2900  
Cause  
Scanning print head alignment sheet failed.  
What to Do  
Press the printer's OK button and check the following.  
• Make sure the print head alignment sheet is set in the correct position and orientation on the platen.  
• Make sure the platen and the print head alignment sheet are not dirty.  
• Make sure the loaded paper is correct.  
For print head alignment, load A4 or Letter-sized plain paper.  
• Make sure the print head nozzle is not clogged.  
Check the print head condition by printing the nozzle check pattern.  
After checking the above, start over auto print head alignment from the beginning.  
If the error is still not resolved, try manual print head alignment.  
449  
 
2901  
Cause  
Print head alignment pattern has been printed and printer is waiting to scan sheet.  
What to Do  
Scan the printed alignment pattern.  
1. Load print head alignment sheet on platen.  
Place the printed side down and align the mark  
alignment mark  
in the upper left corner of the sheet with the  
.
2. Slowly close the document cover and press printer's Black or Color button.  
The printer starts scanning the print head alignment sheet, and automatically adjusts the print head  
position.  
450  
 
4103  
Cause  
Cannot perform printing with current print settings.  
What to Do  
Press the printer's Stop button to cancel printing.  
Then change the print settings and retry printing.  
451  
 
5011  
Cause  
Printer error has occurred.  
What to Do  
Turn off printer and unplug it.  
Plug in the printer again and turn it back on.  
If this does not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.  
Important  
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.  
452  
 
5012  
Cause  
Printer error has occurred.  
What to Do  
Turn off printer and unplug it.  
Plug in the printer again and turn it back on.  
If this does not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.  
Important  
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.  
453  
 
5100  
Cause  
Printer error has occurred.  
What to Do  
Cancel printing and turn off the printer.  
Check the following:  
• Make sure FINE cartridge holder motion is not impeded by stabilizer, jammed paper, etc.  
Remove any impediment.  
• Make sure the FINE cartridges are properly installed.  
Push up the FINE cartridge until it clicks into place.  
Turn the printer back on.  
If this does not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.  
Important  
• When clearing an impediment to FINE cartridge holder motion, be careful not to touch clear film (A).  
If you soil or scratch this part by touching it with paper or your hand, it could damage the printer.  
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.  
454  
 
5200  
Cause  
Printer error has occurred.  
What to Do  
Turn off printer and unplug it.  
Plug in the printer again and turn it back on.  
If this does not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.  
Important  
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.  
455  
 
5B02  
Cause  
Printer error has occurred.  
What to Do  
Contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.  
Important  
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.  
Note  
• In the case of warnings or errors caused by remaining ink levels, the printer cannot print or scan.  
456  
 
6000  
Cause  
Printer error has occurred.  
What to Do  
If the paper is jammed, remove it depending on the jammed location and cause.  
Turn off printer and unplug it.  
Plug in the printer again and turn it back on.  
If this does not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.  
Important  
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.  
457  
 

Skil 7305 User Manual
Schumacher Scf 10000a User Manual
Panasonic Cw Xc103vu User Manual
Mitsubishi Motors Automobile Parts F9q User Manual
JVC DLA VS2500G User Manual
HP COMPAQ NC8230 User Manual
DBTECHNOLOGIES VIOX15 User Manual
CRAFTSMAN CMXEVBE175940 User Manual
CRAFTSMAN 580.767451 User Manual
ACER EV W57H User Manual